US11594567B2 - Solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus - Google Patents
Solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US11594567B2 US11594567B2 US16/495,310 US201816495310A US11594567B2 US 11594567 B2 US11594567 B2 US 11594567B2 US 201816495310 A US201816495310 A US 201816495310A US 11594567 B2 US11594567 B2 US 11594567B2
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- substrate
- wiring layer
- solid
- state imaging
- imaging device
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Active, expires
Links
- 238000003384 imaging method Methods 0.000 title claims abstract description 692
- 239000000758 substrate Substances 0.000 claims abstract description 2415
- 230000008878 coupling Effects 0.000 claims abstract description 279
- 238000010168 coupling process Methods 0.000 claims abstract description 279
- 238000005859 coupling reaction Methods 0.000 claims abstract description 279
- 239000004065 semiconductor Substances 0.000 claims abstract description 156
- 239000004020 conductor Substances 0.000 claims description 106
- 238000012545 processing Methods 0.000 claims description 56
- 230000006870 function Effects 0.000 claims description 48
- 230000035515 penetration Effects 0.000 claims 7
- 239000010410 layer Substances 0.000 description 1356
- 229910052751 metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 479
- 239000002184 metal Substances 0.000 description 479
- 238000010586 diagram Methods 0.000 description 64
- 238000000034 method Methods 0.000 description 33
- 241000724291 Tobacco streak virus Species 0.000 description 27
- 238000006243 chemical reaction Methods 0.000 description 27
- 238000005516 engineering process Methods 0.000 description 25
- 238000004891 communication Methods 0.000 description 22
- 239000000463 material Substances 0.000 description 21
- 238000012546 transfer Methods 0.000 description 19
- 230000003071 parasitic effect Effects 0.000 description 16
- 230000003287 optical effect Effects 0.000 description 15
- 230000003247 decreasing effect Effects 0.000 description 14
- 239000010949 copper Substances 0.000 description 13
- 230000000149 penetrating effect Effects 0.000 description 13
- 230000008569 process Effects 0.000 description 13
- 239000011347 resin Substances 0.000 description 12
- 229920005989 resin Polymers 0.000 description 12
- 238000002674 endoscopic surgery Methods 0.000 description 11
- 239000011810 insulating material Substances 0.000 description 10
- 230000002093 peripheral effect Effects 0.000 description 10
- 230000000694 effects Effects 0.000 description 8
- 210000001519 tissue Anatomy 0.000 description 8
- 230000005540 biological transmission Effects 0.000 description 7
- 230000008859 change Effects 0.000 description 7
- 229910052594 sapphire Inorganic materials 0.000 description 7
- 239000010980 sapphire Substances 0.000 description 7
- 238000001356 surgical procedure Methods 0.000 description 7
- 238000001312 dry etching Methods 0.000 description 6
- 239000011229 interlayer Substances 0.000 description 6
- 238000000926 separation method Methods 0.000 description 6
- VYPSYNLAJGMNEJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Silicium dioxide Chemical compound O=[Si]=O VYPSYNLAJGMNEJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 230000015572 biosynthetic process Effects 0.000 description 5
- 230000012447 hatching Effects 0.000 description 5
- 239000012212 insulator Substances 0.000 description 5
- 239000007769 metal material Substances 0.000 description 5
- 229910052814 silicon oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 5
- 238000009825 accumulation Methods 0.000 description 4
- 230000007423 decrease Effects 0.000 description 4
- 230000005284 excitation Effects 0.000 description 4
- 230000007246 mechanism Effects 0.000 description 4
- 208000005646 Pneumoperitoneum Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 229910052581 Si3N4 Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 229910052782 aluminium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 230000008901 benefit Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000003086 colorant Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229910052802 copper Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 238000009792 diffusion process Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000005530 etching Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000001678 irradiating effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 229910052710 silicon Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 239000010703 silicon Substances 0.000 description 3
- HQVNEWCFYHHQES-UHFFFAOYSA-N silicon nitride Chemical compound N12[Si]34N5[Si]62N3[Si]51N64 HQVNEWCFYHHQES-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 239000010936 titanium Substances 0.000 description 3
- WFKWXMTUELFFGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N tungsten Chemical compound [W] WFKWXMTUELFFGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 229910052721 tungsten Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 239000010937 tungsten Substances 0.000 description 3
- RYGMFSIKBFXOCR-UHFFFAOYSA-N Copper Chemical compound [Cu] RYGMFSIKBFXOCR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- XUIMIQQOPSSXEZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Silicon Chemical compound [Si] XUIMIQQOPSSXEZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- RTAQQCXQSZGOHL-UHFFFAOYSA-N Titanium Chemical compound [Ti] RTAQQCXQSZGOHL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- NRTOMJZYCJJWKI-UHFFFAOYSA-N Titanium nitride Chemical compound [Ti]#N NRTOMJZYCJJWKI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- XAGFODPZIPBFFR-UHFFFAOYSA-N aluminium Chemical compound [Al] XAGFODPZIPBFFR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000004888 barrier function Effects 0.000 description 2
- 210000004204 blood vessel Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 239000003153 chemical reaction reagent Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000001514 detection method Methods 0.000 description 2
- MOFVSTNWEDAEEK-UHFFFAOYSA-M indocyanine green Chemical compound [Na+].[O-]S(=O)(=O)CCCCN1C2=CC=C3C=CC=CC3=C2C(C)(C)C1=CC=CC=CC=CC1=[N+](CCCCS([O-])(=O)=O)C2=CC=C(C=CC=C3)C3=C2C1(C)C MOFVSTNWEDAEEK-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 2
- 229960004657 indocyanine green Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 238000009434 installation Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000001151 other effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 229910000679 solder Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 239000013589 supplement Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910052719 titanium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- JBRZTFJDHDCESZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N AsGa Chemical compound [As]#[Ga] JBRZTFJDHDCESZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FYYHWMGAXLPEAU-UHFFFAOYSA-N Magnesium Chemical compound [Mg] FYYHWMGAXLPEAU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 240000004050 Pentaglottis sempervirens Species 0.000 description 1
- 235000004522 Pentaglottis sempervirens Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- QCWXUUIWCKQGHC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Zirconium Chemical compound [Zr] QCWXUUIWCKQGHC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000001133 acceleration Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000004075 alteration Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000740 bleeding effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000000746 body region Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 238000002485 combustion reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000000295 complement effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000002131 composite material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000012141 concentrate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000011109 contamination Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000007547 defect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000011161 development Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000018109 developmental process Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003989 dielectric material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000007599 discharging Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000009977 dual effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000005684 electric field Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000002349 favourable effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000007667 floating Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000004313 glare Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229910052735 hafnium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- VBJZVLUMGGDVMO-UHFFFAOYSA-N hafnium atom Chemical compound [Hf] VBJZVLUMGGDVMO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910000449 hafnium oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- WIHZLLGSGQNAGK-UHFFFAOYSA-N hafnium(4+);oxygen(2-) Chemical compound [O-2].[O-2].[Hf+4] WIHZLLGSGQNAGK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- CJNBYAVZURUTKZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N hafnium(IV) oxide Inorganic materials O=[Hf]=O CJNBYAVZURUTKZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000010438 heat treatment Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000012535 impurity Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052747 lanthanoid Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 150000002602 lanthanoids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 230000031700 light absorption Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229910052749 magnesium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000011777 magnesium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000002739 metals Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000003595 mist Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000000116 mitigating effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000012986 modification Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000004048 modification Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000004400 mucous membrane Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 239000013307 optical fiber Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000012782 phase change material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000000206 photolithography Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000007639 printing Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000004044 response Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000007789 sealing Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000035945 sensitivity Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000035939 shock Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000008054 signal transmission Effects 0.000 description 1
- HBMJWWWQQXIZIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N silicon carbide Chemical compound [Si+]#[C-] HBMJWWWQQXIZIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000002194 synthesizing effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229910052715 tantalum Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- GUVRBAGPIYLISA-UHFFFAOYSA-N tantalum atom Chemical compound [Ta] GUVRBAGPIYLISA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MZLGASXMSKOWSE-UHFFFAOYSA-N tantalum nitride Chemical compound [Ta]#N MZLGASXMSKOWSE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000002123 temporal effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229910052727 yttrium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- VWQVUPCCIRVNHF-UHFFFAOYSA-N yttrium atom Chemical compound [Y] VWQVUPCCIRVNHF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052726 zirconium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
Images
Classifications
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L21/00—Processes or apparatus adapted for the manufacture or treatment of semiconductor or solid state devices or of parts thereof
- H01L21/02—Manufacture or treatment of semiconductor devices or of parts thereof
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L25/00—Assemblies consisting of a plurality of individual semiconductor or other solid state devices ; Multistep manufacturing processes thereof
- H01L25/03—Assemblies consisting of a plurality of individual semiconductor or other solid state devices ; Multistep manufacturing processes thereof all the devices being of a type provided for in the same subgroup of groups H01L27/00 - H01L33/00, or in a single subclass of H10K, H10N, e.g. assemblies of rectifier diodes
- H01L25/04—Assemblies consisting of a plurality of individual semiconductor or other solid state devices ; Multistep manufacturing processes thereof all the devices being of a type provided for in the same subgroup of groups H01L27/00 - H01L33/00, or in a single subclass of H10K, H10N, e.g. assemblies of rectifier diodes the devices not having separate containers
- H01L25/065—Assemblies consisting of a plurality of individual semiconductor or other solid state devices ; Multistep manufacturing processes thereof all the devices being of a type provided for in the same subgroup of groups H01L27/00 - H01L33/00, or in a single subclass of H10K, H10N, e.g. assemblies of rectifier diodes the devices not having separate containers the devices being of a type provided for in group H01L27/00
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L25/00—Assemblies consisting of a plurality of individual semiconductor or other solid state devices ; Multistep manufacturing processes thereof
- H01L25/03—Assemblies consisting of a plurality of individual semiconductor or other solid state devices ; Multistep manufacturing processes thereof all the devices being of a type provided for in the same subgroup of groups H01L27/00 - H01L33/00, or in a single subclass of H10K, H10N, e.g. assemblies of rectifier diodes
- H01L25/04—Assemblies consisting of a plurality of individual semiconductor or other solid state devices ; Multistep manufacturing processes thereof all the devices being of a type provided for in the same subgroup of groups H01L27/00 - H01L33/00, or in a single subclass of H10K, H10N, e.g. assemblies of rectifier diodes the devices not having separate containers
- H01L25/07—Assemblies consisting of a plurality of individual semiconductor or other solid state devices ; Multistep manufacturing processes thereof all the devices being of a type provided for in the same subgroup of groups H01L27/00 - H01L33/00, or in a single subclass of H10K, H10N, e.g. assemblies of rectifier diodes the devices not having separate containers the devices being of a type provided for in group H01L29/00
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L25/00—Assemblies consisting of a plurality of individual semiconductor or other solid state devices ; Multistep manufacturing processes thereof
- H01L25/18—Assemblies consisting of a plurality of individual semiconductor or other solid state devices ; Multistep manufacturing processes thereof the devices being of types provided for in two or more different subgroups of the same main group of groups H01L27/00 - H01L33/00, or in a single subclass of H10K, H10N
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L27/00—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate
- H01L27/14—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate including semiconductor components sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation
- H01L27/144—Devices controlled by radiation
- H01L27/146—Imager structures
- H01L27/14601—Structural or functional details thereof
- H01L27/14603—Special geometry or disposition of pixel-elements, address-lines or gate-electrodes
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L27/00—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate
- H01L27/14—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate including semiconductor components sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation
- H01L27/144—Devices controlled by radiation
- H01L27/146—Imager structures
- H01L27/14601—Structural or functional details thereof
- H01L27/14634—Assemblies, i.e. Hybrid structures
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L27/00—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate
- H01L27/14—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate including semiconductor components sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation
- H01L27/144—Devices controlled by radiation
- H01L27/146—Imager structures
- H01L27/14601—Structural or functional details thereof
- H01L27/14636—Interconnect structures
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L27/00—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate
- H01L27/14—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate including semiconductor components sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation
- H01L27/144—Devices controlled by radiation
- H01L27/146—Imager structures
- H01L27/14683—Processes or apparatus peculiar to the manufacture or treatment of these devices or parts thereof
- H01L27/1469—Assemblies, i.e. hybrid integration
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2224/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies and methods related thereto as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2224/01—Means for bonding being attached to, or being formed on, the surface to be connected, e.g. chip-to-package, die-attach, "first-level" interconnects; Manufacturing methods related thereto
- H01L2224/02—Bonding areas; Manufacturing methods related thereto
- H01L2224/07—Structure, shape, material or disposition of the bonding areas after the connecting process
- H01L2224/08—Structure, shape, material or disposition of the bonding areas after the connecting process of an individual bonding area
- H01L2224/081—Disposition
- H01L2224/0812—Disposition the bonding area connecting directly to another bonding area, i.e. connectorless bonding, e.g. bumpless bonding
- H01L2224/08135—Disposition the bonding area connecting directly to another bonding area, i.e. connectorless bonding, e.g. bumpless bonding the bonding area connecting between different semiconductor or solid-state bodies, i.e. chip-to-chip
- H01L2224/08145—Disposition the bonding area connecting directly to another bonding area, i.e. connectorless bonding, e.g. bumpless bonding the bonding area connecting between different semiconductor or solid-state bodies, i.e. chip-to-chip the bodies being stacked
Definitions
- the present disclosure relates to a solid-state imaging device and an electronic apparatus.
- Solid-state imaging devices each of which has a structure in which a pixel chip provided with a pixel unit, a logic chip mounted with a logic circuit, and the like are stacked.
- the logic circuit executes various kinds of signal processing related to the operation of the solid-state imaging device.
- PTL 1 discloses a three-layer stacked solid-state imaging device in which a pixel chip, a logic chip, and a memory chip mounted with a memory circuit are stacked.
- the memory circuit holds a pixel signal acquired by a pixel unit of the pixel chip.
- this specification also refers, as “substrates,” to components each including, in combination, a semiconductor substrate having a pixel chip, a logic chip, or a memory chip formed thereon, and a multi-layered wiring layer formed on the semiconductor substrate.
- the “substrates” are then referred to as “first substrate,” “second substrate,” “third substrate,” . . . in order from the upper side (side from which observation light comes) to the lower side of the stack structure to distinguish the substrates from each other.
- the stacked solid-state imaging device is manufactured by stacking the respective substrates in the wafer state, and then dicing the stacked substrates into a plurality of stacked solid-state imaging devices (stacked solid-state imaging device chips).
- the “substrates” may mean the wafer state before dicing, or the chip state after dicing.
- the present disclosure proposes a novel and improved solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus that allow performance to be further improved.
- a solid-state imaging device including: a first substrate; a second substrate; and a third substrate that are stacked in this order.
- the first substrate includes a first semiconductor substrate and a first multi-layered wiring layer stacked on the first semiconductor substrate.
- the first semiconductor substrate has a pixel unit formed thereon.
- the pixel unit has pixels arranged thereon.
- the second substrate includes a second semiconductor substrate and a second multi-layered wiring layer stacked on the second semiconductor substrate.
- the second semiconductor substrate has a circuit formed thereon.
- the circuit has a predetermined function.
- the third substrate includes a third semiconductor substrate and a third multi-layered wiring layer stacked on the third semiconductor substrate.
- the third semiconductor substrate has a circuit formed thereon.
- the circuit has a predetermined function.
- a first coupling structure for electrically coupling at least two of the first substrate, the second substrate, or the third substrate to each other includes a via.
- the via has a structure in which an electrically-conductive material is embedded in one through hole provided to expose a predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer while exposing a portion of a predetermined wiring line in the first multi-layered wiring layer from a back surface side of the first substrate, or one through hole provided to expose a predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer while exposing a portion of the predetermined wiring line in the first multi-layered wiring layer or the second multi-layered wiring layer from the back surface side of the first substrate, or a structure in which a film including an electrically-conductive material is formed on an inner wall of the through hole.
- an electronic apparatus including a solid-state imaging device that electronically shoots an image of an object to be observed.
- the solid-state imaging device includes a first substrate, a second substrate, and a third substrate that are stacked in this order.
- the first substrate includes a first semiconductor substrate and a first multi-layered wiring layer stacked on the first semiconductor substrate.
- the first semiconductor substrate has a pixel unit formed thereon.
- the pixel unit has pixels arranged thereon.
- the second substrate includes a second semiconductor substrate and a second multi-layered wiring layer stacked on the second semiconductor substrate.
- the second semiconductor substrate has a circuit formed thereon.
- the circuit has a predetermined function.
- the third substrate includes a third semiconductor substrate and a third multi-layered wiring layer stacked on the third semiconductor substrate.
- the third semiconductor substrate has a circuit formed thereon.
- the circuit has a predetermined function.
- the first substrate and the second substrate are bonded together in a manner that the first multi-layered wiring layer and the second multi-layered wiring layer are opposed to each other.
- a first coupling structure for electrically coupling at least two of the first substrate, the second substrate, or the third substrate to each other includes a via.
- the via has a structure in which an electrically-conductive material is embedded in one through hole provided to expose a predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer while exposing a portion of a predetermined wiring line in the first multi-layered wiring layer from a back surface side of the first substrate, or one through hole provided to expose a predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer while exposing a portion of the predetermined wiring line in the first multi-layered wiring layer or the second multi-layered wiring layer from the back surface side of the first substrate, or a structure in which a film including an electrically-conductive material is formed on an inner wall of the through hole.
- a first substrate serving as a pixel substrate and a second substrate are bonded face to face (details are described below), and a via (i.e., shared contact type two-layer or three-layer via that is formed from a back surface side of the first substrate, and is described below) is provided as a coupling structure for electrically coupling respective signal lines included in at least two of the first substrate, the second substrate, or a third substrate to each other and electrically coupling respective power supply lines included in at least two of the first substrate, the second substrate, or the third substrate to each other.
- a via i.e., shared contact type two-layer or three-layer via that is formed from a back surface side of the first substrate, and is described below
- the via has a structure in which an electrically-conductive material is embedded in one through hole provided to expose a predetermined wiring line in a second multi-layered wiring layer of the second substrate while exposing a portion of a predetermined wiring line in a first multi-layered wiring layer of the first substrate from the back surface side of the first substrate, or one through hole provided to expose a predetermined wiring line in a third multi-layered wiring layer of the third substrate while exposing a portion of the predetermined wiring line in the first multi-layered wiring layer or the second multi-layered wiring layer from the back surface side of the first substrate, or a structure in which a film including an electrically-conductive material is formed on an inner wall of the through hole.
- various coupling structures are further provided as a second coupling structure for electrically coupling respective signal lines included in the second substrate and the third substrate to each other and electrically coupling respective power supply lines included in the second substrate and the third substrate to each other, and/or as a third coupling structure for electrically coupling respective signal lines included in the first substrate and the third substrate to each other and electrically coupling respective power supply lines included in the first substrate and the third substrate to each other, which makes it possible to achieve many variations of the coupling structure. This makes it possible to achieve a superior solid-state imaging device that allow performance to be further improved.
- FIG. 1 is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to an embodiment of the present disclosure.
- FIG. 2 A is a diagram for describing an example of disposition of coupling structures of the solid-state imaging device in a horizontal plane.
- FIG. 2 B is a diagram for describing an example of the disposition of the coupling structures of the solid-state imaging device in the horizontal plane.
- FIG. 2 C is a diagram for describing another example of the disposition of the coupling structures of the solid-state imaging device in the horizontal plane.
- FIG. 2 D is a diagram for describing another example of the disposition of the coupling structures of the solid-state imaging device in the horizontal plane.
- FIG. 2 E is a diagram for describing still another example of the disposition of the coupling structures of the solid-state imaging device in the horizontal plane.
- FIG. 2 F is a diagram for describing still another example of the disposition of the coupling structures of the solid-state imaging device in the horizontal plane.
- FIG. 3 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device in which a first substrate and a second substrate are bonded together F-to-F.
- FIG. 3 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device in which the first substrate and the second substrate are bonded together F-to-B.
- FIG. 4 A is a diagram for describing parasitic capacitance between a PWELL and a power supply wiring line in the solid-state imaging device illustrated in FIG. 3 A .
- FIG. 4 B is a diagram for describing parasitic capacitance between a PWELL and a power supply wiring line in the solid-state imaging device illustrated in FIG. 3 B .
- FIG. 5 A is a diagram schematically illustrating disposition of power supply wiring lines and GND wiring lines in the solid-state imaging device illustrated in FIG. 3 A .
- FIG. 5 B is a diagram schematically illustrating disposition of power supply wiring lines and GND wiring lines in the solid-state imaging device illustrated in FIG. 3 B .
- FIG. 5 C is a diagram illustrating a configuration example of the solid-state imaging device illustrated in FIG. 5 A for decreasing impedance.
- FIG. 6 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a first configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 6 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the first configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 6 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the first configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 6 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the first configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 6 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the first configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 6 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the first configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 6 G is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the first configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 6 H is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the first configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 6 I is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the first configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 6 J is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the first configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 6 K is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the first configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 6 L is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the first configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 6 M is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the first configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 7 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a second configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 7 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the second configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 7 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the second configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 7 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the second configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 8 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a third configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 8 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the third configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 8 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the third configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 8 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the third configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 8 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the third configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 8 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the third configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 9 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a fourth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 9 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fourth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 9 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fourth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 9 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fourth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 10 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a fifth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 10 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fifth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 10 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fifth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 10 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fifth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 10 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fifth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 10 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fifth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 11 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a sixth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 11 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the sixth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 11 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the sixth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 11 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the sixth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 11 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the sixth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 12 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a seventh configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 12 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the seventh configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 12 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the seventh configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 12 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the seventh configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 13 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to an eighth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 13 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 13 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 13 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 13 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 13 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 14 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a ninth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 14 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the ninth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 14 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the ninth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 14 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the ninth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 15 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a tenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 15 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the tenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 15 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the tenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 15 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the tenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 15 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the tenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 15 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the tenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 16 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to an eleventh configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 16 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eleventh configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 16 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eleventh configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 16 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eleventh configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 16 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eleventh configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 16 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eleventh configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 17 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a twelfth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 17 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the twelfth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 17 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the twelfth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 17 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the twelfth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 17 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the twelfth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 18 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a thirteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 18 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the thirteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 18 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the thirteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 18 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the thirteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 18 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the thirteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 18 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the thirteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 18 G is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the thirteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 18 H is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the thirteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 18 I is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the thirteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 18 J is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the thirteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 19 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a fourteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 19 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fourteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 19 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fourteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 19 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fourteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 19 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fourteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 20 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a fifteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 20 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fifteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 20 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fifteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 20 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fifteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 20 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fifteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 20 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fifteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 21 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a sixteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 21 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the sixteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 21 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the sixteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 21 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the sixteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 21 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the sixteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 21 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the sixteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 22 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a seventeenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 22 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the seventeenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 22 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the seventeenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 22 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the seventeenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 22 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the seventeenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 23 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to an eighteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 23 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 23 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 23 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 23 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 23 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 23 G is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 23 H is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 23 I is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 23 J is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 24 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a nineteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 24 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the nineteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 24 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the nineteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 24 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the nineteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 24 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the nineteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 25 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to a twentieth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 25 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the twentieth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 25 C is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the twentieth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 25 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the twentieth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 25 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the twentieth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- FIG. 26 A is a diagram illustrating appearance of a smartphone that is an example of an electronic apparatus to which a solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may be applied.
- FIG. 26 B is a diagram illustrating appearance of a digital camera that is another example of the electronic apparatus to which the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may be applied.
- FIG. 26 C is a diagram illustrating appearance of a digital camera that is another example of the electronic apparatus to which the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may be applied.
- FIG. 27 A is a cross-sectional view of a configuration example of a solid-state imaging device to which technology according to the present disclosure may be applied.
- FIG. 27 B is an explanatory diagram illustrating a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device to which the technology according to the present disclosure may be applied.
- FIG. 27 C is an explanatory diagram illustrating a configuration example of a video camera to which the technology according to the present disclosure may be applied.
- FIG. 27 D is a view depicting an example of a schematic configuration of an endoscopic surgery system.
- FIG. 27 E is a block diagram depicting an example of a functional configuration of a camera head and a camera control unit (CCU).
- CCU camera control unit
- FIG. 27 F is a block diagram depicting an example of schematic configuration of a vehicle control system.
- FIG. 27 G is a diagram of assistance in explaining an example of installation positions of an outside-vehicle information detecting section and an imaging section.
- FIG. 1 is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device according to an embodiment of the present disclosure.
- a solid-state imaging device 1 according to the present embodiment is a three-layer stacked solid-state imaging device including a first substrate 110 A, a second substrate 110 B, and a third substrate 110 C that are stacked.
- a broken line A-A indicates the bonding surfaces of the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B
- a broken line B-B indicates the bonding surfaces of the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C.
- the first substrate 110 A is a pixel substrate provided with a pixel unit.
- the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C are provided with circuits for performing various kinds of signal processing related to the operation of the solid-state imaging device 1 .
- the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C are, for example, a logic substrate provided with a logic circuit or a memory substrate provided with a memory circuit.
- the solid-state imaging device 1 is a back-illuminated CMOS (Complementary Metal-Oxide-Semiconductor) image sensor that photoelectrically converts, in a pixel unit, light coming from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A, which is described below. Note that the following describes, for the explanation of FIG. 1 , a case where the second substrate 110 B is a logic substrate, and the third substrate 110 C is a memory substrate, as an example.
- CMOS Complementary Metal-Oxide-Semiconductor
- the stacked solid-state imaging device 1 It is possible in the stacked solid-state imaging device 1 to more appropriately configure circuits to adapt to the functions of the respective substrates. It is thus easier to allow the solid-state imaging device 1 to exhibit higher performance. It is possible in the illustrated configuration example to appropriately configure the pixel unit in the first substrate 110 A, and the logic circuit or the memory circuit in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to adapt to the functions of the respective substrates. This makes it possible to achieve the solid-state imaging device 1 that exhibits high performance.
- the following also refers to the stacking direction of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C as z-axis direction.
- the direction in which the first substrate 110 A is positioned in the z-axis direction is defined as the positive direction of the z axis.
- two directions orthogonal to each other on the plane (horizontal plane) vertical to the z-axis direction are also referred to as x-axis direction and y-axis direction.
- one of the opposed two surfaces of semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 on the respective substrates in the directions of the substrate principal surfaces is provided with functional components such as transistors or is provided with multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 for bringing the functional components into operation, and the following also refers to these surfaces as front surfaces (front side surfaces).
- the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 are described below.
- the semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 are described below.
- the other surfaces opposed to the front surfaces are also referred to as back surfaces (back side surfaces).
- a side on which the front surface is provided is also referred to as front surface side (front side)
- a side on which the back surface is provided is also referred to as back surface side (back side).
- the first substrate 110 A mainly includes the semiconductor substrate 101 including, for example, silicon (Si), and the multi-layered wiring layer 105 formed on the semiconductor substrate 101 .
- a pixel unit having pixels two-dimensionally arranged thereon, and a pixel signal processing circuit that processes a pixel signal are mainly formed.
- Each pixel mainly includes a photodiode (PD) that receives light (observation light) from an observation target and performs photoelectric conversion, and a drive circuit including a transistor or the like for reading out an electric signal (pixel signal) corresponding to the observation light acquired by the PD.
- PD photodiode
- AD conversion analog-to-digital conversion
- the pixel unit is not limited to a pixel unit including pixels that are two-dimensionally arranged, but may include a pixel unit including pixels that are three-dimensionally arranged.
- a substrate formed using a material other than a semiconductor may be used instead of the semiconductor substrate 101 .
- a sapphire substrate may be used instead of the semiconductor substrate 101 .
- a mode may be applied in which a film that performs photoelectric conversion (e.g., an organic photoelectric conversion film) is deposited on the sapphire substrate to form a pixel.
- An insulating film 103 is stacked on the front surface of the semiconductor substrate 101 on which the pixel unit and the pixel signal processing circuit are formed. Inside the insulating film 103 is formed the multi-layered wiring layer 105 including signal line wiring for transmitting various signals, such as a pixel signal and a drive signal for driving a transistor of the drive circuit.
- the multi-layered wiring layer 105 further includes a power supply wiring line, a ground wiring line (GND wiring line), and the like.
- the signal line wiring may be simply referred to as signal lines for simplicity.
- the power supply wiring line and the GND wiring line are sometimes collectively referred to as power supply line.
- the lowermost wiring line of the multi-layered wiring layer 105 may be electrically coupled to the pixel unit or the pixel signal processing circuit by a contact 107 in which an electrically-conductive material such as tungsten (W) is embedded, for example.
- a wiring layer including a plurality of layers may be actually formed by repeating the formation of an interlayer insulating film having a predetermined thickness and the formation of a wiring layer, but FIG. 1 collectively refers to these interlayer insulating films in the plurality of layers as insulating film 103 , and collectively refers to the wiring layers in the plurality of layers as multi-layered wiring layer 105 for the sake of simplicity.
- the second substrate 110 B is, for example, a logic substrate.
- the second substrate 110 B mainly includes the semiconductor substrate 121 including, for example, Si, and the multi-layered wiring layer 125 formed on the semiconductor substrate 121 .
- a logic circuit is formed on the semiconductor substrate 121 .
- the logic circuit may control a drive signal for driving the pixel unit of the first substrate 110 A (i.e., drive control of the pixel unit) or control an exchange of a signal with the outside.
- a substrate formed using a material other than a semiconductor may be used instead of the semiconductor substrate 121 .
- a sapphire substrate may be used instead of the semiconductor substrate 121 .
- a mode may be applied in which a semiconductor film (e.g., a Si film) is deposited on the sapphire substrate, and a logic circuit is formed in the semiconductor film.
- a semiconductor film e.g., a Si film
- An insulating film 123 is stacked on the front surface of the semiconductor substrate 121 on which the logic circuit is formed.
- the multi-layered wiring layer 125 for transmitting various signals related to the operation of the logic circuit is formed inside the insulating film 123 .
- the multi-layered wiring layer 125 further includes a power supply wiring line, a GND wiring line, and the like.
- the lowermost wiring line of the multi-layered wiring layer 125 may be electrically coupled to the logic circuit by a contact 127 in which an electrically-conductive material such as W is embedded, for example.
- the insulating film 123 of the second substrate 110 B may also be a collective term of interlayer insulating films in a plurality of layers
- the multi-layered wiring layer 125 may be a collective term of wiring layers in a plurality of layers.
- the pad 151 may be formed in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 .
- the pad 151 functions as an external input/output unit (I/O unit) for exchanging various signals with the outside.
- the pad 151 may be provided along the outer periphery of the chip.
- the third substrate 110 C is, for example, a memory substrate.
- the third substrate 110 C mainly includes the semiconductor substrate 131 including, for example, Si, and the multi-layered wiring layer 135 formed on the semiconductor substrate 131 .
- a memory circuit is formed on the semiconductor substrate 131 .
- the memory circuit temporarily holds a pixel signal acquired by the pixel unit of the first substrate 110 A and subjected to AD conversion by the pixel signal processing circuit. Temporarily holding a pixel signal in the memory circuit enables a global shutter, and allows the pixel signal to be read out from the solid-state imaging device 1 to the outside at higher speed. Therefore, even at the time of high-speed shooting, it is possible to shoot an image of higher quality in which distortion is suppressed.
- a substrate formed using a material other than a semiconductor may be used instead of the semiconductor substrate 131 .
- a sapphire substrate may be used instead of the semiconductor substrate 131 .
- a mode may be applied in which a film for forming a memory element (e.g., a phase change material film) is deposited on the sapphire substrate, and a memory circuit is formed using the film.
- a memory element e.g., a phase change material film
- An insulating film 133 is stacked on the front surface of the semiconductor substrate 131 on which the memory circuit is formed.
- the multi-layered wiring layer 135 for transmitting various signals related to the operation of the memory circuit is formed inside the insulating film 133 .
- the multi-layered wiring layer 135 further includes a power supply wiring line, a GND wiring line, and the like.
- the lowermost wiring line of the multi-layered wiring layer 135 may be electrically coupled to the memory circuit by a contact 137 in which an electrically-conductive material such as W is embedded, for example.
- the insulating film 133 of the third substrate 110 C may also be a collective term of interlayer insulating films in a plurality of layers
- the multi-layered wiring layer 135 may be a collective term of wiring layers in a plurality of layers.
- the pad 151 may be formed in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 .
- the pad 151 functions as an I/O unit for exchanging various signals with the outside.
- the pad 151 may be provided along the outer periphery of the chip.
- the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C are each fabricated in the wafer state. Thereafter, these are bonded together, and the respective processes are performed for electrically coupling the signal lines included in the respective substrates to each other and electrically coupling the power supply lines included in the respective substrates to each other.
- the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are first bonded together in a manner that the front surface (surface provided with the multi-layered wiring layer 105 ) of the semiconductor substrate 101 of the first substrate 110 A in the wafer state and the front surface (surface provided with the multi-layered wiring layer 125 ) of the semiconductor substrate 121 of the second substrate 110 B in the wafer state are opposed to each other.
- the following also refers to such a state in which two substrates are bonded together with the front surfaces of the respective semiconductor substrates opposed to each other as Face to Face (F-to-F).
- the third substrate 110 C in the wafer state is further bonded to the stack of the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B in a manner that the back surface (the surface opposite to the side on which the multi-layered wiring layer 125 is provided) of the semiconductor substrate 121 of the second substrate 110 B in the wafer state and the front surface (the surface on which the multi-layered wiring layer 135 is provided) of the semiconductor substrate 131 of the third substrate 110 C are opposed to each other.
- the semiconductor substrate 121 of the second substrate 110 B is thinned, and an insulating film 129 having a predetermined thickness is formed on the back surface side thereof.
- the following also refers to such a state in which two substrates are bonded together with the front surface and back surface of the respective semiconductor substrates opposed to each other as Face to Back (F-to-B).
- a TSV 157 is formed to electrically couple the respective signal lines in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- a wiring line in one substrate being electrically coupled to a wiring line in another substrate may be abbreviated for simplicity as the one substrate being electrically coupled to the other substrate.
- the wiring lines electrically coupled actually when the substrates are expressed as being electrically coupled to each other may be signal lines or power supply lines.
- the TSV herein means a via provided by penetrating at least one of the semiconductor substrate 101 , 121 , or 131 from one surface of any of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C.
- a substrate including a material other than a semiconductor may also be used instead of the semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 , but this specification also refers to a via provided by penetrating such a substrate including a material other than a semiconductor as TSV for the sake of convenience.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 is formed by forming one through hole (opening that penetrates at least one semiconductor substrate), and embedding an electrically-conductive material in the through hole.
- the through hole reaches a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A while exposing a portion of a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV that electrically couples wiring lines of a plurality of substrates to each other by one through hole is also referred to as shared contact.
- Using the shared contact provides an advantage that a TSV structure is achievable by a relatively simple process and in a relatively small area.
- the TSV 157 is formed by embedding, in a through hole, a first metal (e.g., copper (Cu)) that is described below and included in each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 .
- a first metal e.g., copper (Cu)
- the electrically-conductive material included in the TSV 157 does not have to be the same as the first metal, but any material may be used as the electrically-conductive material.
- the TSV 157 is formed, and a color filter layer 111 (CF layer 111 ) and a microlens array 113 (ML array 113 ) are then formed on the back surface side of the semiconductor substrate 101 of the first substrate 110 A with the insulating film 109 interposed therebetween.
- CF layer 111 color filter layer 111
- ML array 113 microlens array 113
- the CF layer 111 includes a plurality of CFs that is two-dimensionally arranged.
- the ML array 113 includes a plurality of MLs that is two-dimensionally arranged.
- the CF layer 111 and the ML array 113 are formed directly above the pixel unit, and one CF and one ML are provided to the PD of one pixel.
- Each CF of the CF layer 111 has, for example, any of red, green, and blue colors.
- the observation light that has passed through the CF enters the PD of the pixel, and a pixel signal is acquired.
- one pixel corresponding to one CF functions as a sub-pixel, and one pixel may include a plurality of sub-pixels.
- one pixel may include sub-pixels of four respective colors: a pixel provided with a red CF (i.e., red pixel); a pixel provided with a green CF (i.e., green pixel); a pixel provided with a blue CF (i.e., blue pixel); and a pixel provided with no CF (i.e., white pixel).
- red CF i.e., red pixel
- green CF i.e., green pixel
- a pixel provided with a blue CF i.e., blue pixel
- a pixel provided with no CF i.e., white pixel
- the ML array 113 is formed to position MLs directly above the respective CFs. Providing the ML array 113 allows the observation light collected by an ML to enter the PD of the pixel via the CF. This makes it possible to obtain the effects of improving the efficiency of collecting the observation light and the sensitivity of the solid-state imaging device 1 .
- the CF layer 111 and the ML array 113 are formed, and pad openings 153 a and 153 b are then formed to expose the pads 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C.
- the pad opening 153 a is formed to penetrate the first substrate 110 A from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A, and reach the metal surface of the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B.
- the pad opening 153 b is formed to penetrate the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A, and reach the metal surface of the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C.
- the pads 151 and other external circuits are electrically coupled to each other through the pad openings 153 a and 153 b by, for example, wire bonding. That is, the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C may be electrically coupled to each other and the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C may be electrically coupled to each other through the other external circuit.
- the plurality of these pad openings 153 is distinguished by attaching different alphabets to the end of the reference numeral like pad opening 153 a , pad opening 153 b , . . . for the sake of convenience.
- the stacked wafer structure stacked and processed in a wafer state is diced for each individual solid-state imaging device 1 ; thus, the solid-state imaging device 1 is completed.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other, and the pads 151 exposed by the pad openings 153 a and 153 b are coupled to each other through an electrical coupling means such as a wiring line provided outside the solid-state imaging device 1 , which may electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other, and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- an electrical coupling means such as a wiring line provided outside the solid-state imaging device 1 , which may electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other, and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C may be electrically coupled to each other, and the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C may be electrically coupled to each other through the TSV 157 , the pads 151 , and the pad openings 153 a and 153 b .
- this specification also collectively refers, as coupling structures, to structures such as the TSV 157 , the pads 151 , and the pad openings 153 a and 153 b illustrated in FIG. 1 that may electrically couple the signal lines included in the respective substrates to each other and electrically couple the power supply lines included in the respective substrates to each other.
- the coupling structure also includes an electrode junction structure 159 (structure that exists on the bonding surfaces of the substrates, and is obtained by joining the electrodes formed on the respective bonding surfaces in direct contact with each other) described below.
- the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C may include a plurality of stacked first metal wiring layers 141 each including a first metal having relatively low resistance.
- the first metal is, for example, copper (Cu).
- Cu copper
- the pads 151 may each include a second metal that is different from the first metal, from the perspective of the adhesiveness and the like to wires for wire bonding.
- the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C each provided with the pad 151 each include, in the same layer as that of the pad 151 , a second metal wiring layer 143 including the second metal.
- the second metal is, for example, aluminum (Al).
- Al wiring line may be used, for example, as a power supply wiring line or a ground wiring line that is generally formed as a wide wiring line.
- first metal and the second metal are not limited to Cu or Al exemplified above.
- first metal and the second metal various metals may be used.
- the respective wiring layers of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may each include an electrically-conductive material other than metal. It is sufficient if these wiring layers each include an electrically-conductive material. The materials thereof are not limited.
- all the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 including the pads 151 may include the same electrically-conductive material.
- the TSV 157 , and an electrode and a via included in an electrode junction structure 159 described below also each include the first metal (e.g., Cu).
- the first metal e.g., Cu
- these structures may be formed by a damascene method or a dual damascene method.
- the present embodiment is not, however, limited to the example.
- a portion or all of these structures may include the second metal, another metal different from both the first metal and the second metal, or another non-metallic electrically-conductive material.
- the TSV 157 and a via included in the electrode junction structure 159 may be formed by embedding, in openings, metal materials such as W having favorable embeddability.
- the structure using W may be preferably applied in consideration of the embeddability.
- the TSV 157 does not necessarily have to be formed by embedding an electrically-conductive material in a through hole, but may be formed by forming a film including an electrically-conductive material on the inner wall (sidewall and bottom) of the through hole.
- the solid-state imaging device 1 includes insulating materials for electrically insulating the first metal, the second metal, and the like from the semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 in portions that seem in each diagram to have electrically-conductive materials such as the first metal and the second metal in contact with the semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 .
- the insulating materials may include various known materials such as silicon oxide (SiO 2 ) or silicon nitride (SiN), for example.
- the insulating materials may be interposed between the electrically-conductive materials and the semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 , or may exist inside the semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 away from the portions where the electrically-conductive materials are in contact with the semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 .
- insulating materials may exist between the inner walls of through holes provided in the semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 and electrically-conductive materials embedded in the through holes (i.e., films including the insulating materials may be formed on the inner walls of the through holes).
- insulating materials may exist in portions inside the semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 and away from the through holes provided to the semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 by predetermined distances in the direction of the horizontal plane.
- a barrier metal exists in order to prevent diffusion of Cu in portions where Cu is in contact with the semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 or the insulating films 103 , 109 , 123 , 129 , and 133 in a case where the first metal is Cu.
- the barrier metal various known materials such as titanium nitride (TiN) or tantalum nitride (TaN), for example, may be used.
- the specific configurations of the respective components pixel unit and pixel signal processing circuit provided to the first substrate 110 A, logic circuit provided to the second substrate 110 B, and memory circuit provided to the third substrate 110 C), the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 , and the insulating films 103 , 109 , 123 , 129 , and 133 that are formed on the semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 of the respective substrates, and formation methods thereof may be similar to various known configurations and methods. The specific configurations and formation methods are not thus described here in detail.
- the insulating films 103 , 109 , 123 , 129 , and 133 include materials having insulating properties.
- the materials thereof are not limited.
- the insulating films 103 , 109 , 123 , 129 , and 133 may include, for example, SiO 2 , SiN, or the like.
- each of the insulating films 103 , 109 , 123 , 129 , and 133 does not have to include one type of insulating material, but may include a plurality of types of stacked insulating materials.
- a Low-k material having insulating properties may be used in regions where wiring lines desired to transmit signals at higher speed are formed in the insulating films 103 , 123 , and 133 .
- the use of Low-k materials allows the parasitic capacitance between wiring lines to be decreased, which makes it possible to further contribute to signal transmission at higher speed.
- a pixel signal processing circuit that performs signal processing such as AD conversion on a pixel signal is mounted on the first substrate 110 A, but the present embodiment is not limited to the example.
- a portion or all of the functions of the pixel signal processing circuit may be provided to the second substrate 110 B. This case may achieve the solid-state imaging device 1 that performs so-called pixel-by-pixel analog-to-digital conversion (pixel ADC).
- a pixel signal acquired by a PD provided to each pixel is transmitted to the pixel signal processing circuit of the second substrate 110 B for each pixel, and AD conversion is performed for each pixel, for example, in a pixel array in which a plurality of pixels is arrayed in both a column direction and a row direction.
- This allows pixel signals to be subjected to AD conversion and read out at higher speed as compared with the solid-state imaging device 1 that includes one AD conversion circuit for each column of the pixel array, and performs general column-by-column analog-to-digital conversion (column ADC).
- column ADC a plurality of pixels included in a column is sequentially subjected to AD conversion.
- each pixel is provided with a coupling structure that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the second substrate 110 B is a logic substrate
- the third substrate 110 C is a memory substrate
- the present embodiment is not, however, limited to the example. It is sufficient if the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C are substrates having functions other than that of the pixel substrate, and the functions may be optionally determined.
- the solid-state imaging device 1 does not have to include any memory circuit.
- both the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C may function as logic substrates.
- a logic circuit and a memory circuit may be distributed in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and these substrates may cooperate to achieve the functions of a logic substrate and a memory substrate.
- the second substrate 110 B may be a memory substrate
- the third substrate 110 C may be a logic substrate.
- Si substrates are used as the semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 on the respective substrates, but the present embodiment is not limited to the example.
- the semiconductor substrates 101 , 121 , and 131 other types of semiconductor substrates may be used such as gallium arsenide (GaAs) substrates or silicon carbide (SiC) substrates, for example.
- GaAs gallium arsenide
- SiC silicon carbide
- substrates may be used, for example, such as sapphire substrates each including a material other than a semiconductor.
- the signal lines and/or the power supply lines included in the respective substrates may be electrically coupled to each other over the plurality of substrates through a coupling structure.
- the disposition of these coupling structures in the horizontal plane may be determined as appropriate to improve the performance of the entire solid-state imaging device 1 by considering the configuration, performance, and the like of each of the substrates (chips).
- FIGS. 2 A and 2 B are diagram for describing an example of the disposition of the coupling structures of the solid-state imaging device 1 in the horizontal plane.
- FIGS. 2 A and 2 B each illustrate the disposition of the coupling structures in the solid-state imaging device 1 in a case where a pixel signal processing circuit that performs processing such as AD conversion on a pixel signal is mounted on the first substrate 110 A, for example.
- FIG. 2 A schematically illustrates the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C included in the solid-state imaging device 1 .
- Electrical coupling between the lower surface (surface opposed to the second substrate 110 B) of the first substrate 110 A and the upper surface (surface opposed to the first substrate 110 A) of the second substrate 110 B through coupling structures is indicated by a broken line in a simulated manner
- electrical coupling between the lower surface (surface opposed to the third substrate 110 C) of the second substrate 110 B and the upper surface (surface opposed to the second substrate 110 B) of the third substrate 110 C through coupling structures is indicated by a solid line in a simulated manner.
- the coupling structure 201 functions as an I/O unit for exchanging various signals such as a power supply signal and a GND signal with the outside.
- the coupling structure 201 may be the pad 151 provided to the upper surface of the first substrate 110 A.
- the coupling structure 201 may be the pad opening 153 provided to expose the pad 151 in a case where the pad 151 is provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, or the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C.
- the coupling structure 201 may be a lead line opening 155 described below.
- the first substrate 110 A is provided with the pixel unit 206 in the middle of the chip, and the coupling structures 201 included in the I/O unit are disposed around the pixel unit 206 (i.e., along the outer periphery of the chip).
- pixel signal processing circuits may also be disposed around the pixel unit 206 .
- FIG. 2 B schematically illustrates the positions of coupling structures 202 on the lower surface of the first substrate 110 A, the positions of coupling structures 203 on the upper surface of the second substrate 110 B, the positions of coupling structures 204 on the lower surface of the second substrate 110 B, and the positions of coupling structures 205 on the upper surface of the third substrate 110 C.
- These coupling structures 202 to 205 may be the TSVs 157 or the electrode junction structures 159 provided between the substrates.
- the electrode junction structures 159 are described below. Alternatively, as illustrated in FIG.
- the pad 151 in a case where the pad 151 is provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B or the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C, it may be the pad opening 153 , out of the coupling structures 202 to 205 , that is positioned directly below the coupling structure 201 .
- the pad opening 153 is provided to expose the pad 151 .
- the coupling structures 202 to 205 may be the lead line openings 155 described below.
- FIG. 2 B illustrates the coupling structures 202 to 205 in accordance with the forms of straight lines indicating electrical coupling illustrated in FIG. 2 A .
- the coupling structures 202 on the lower surface of the first substrate 110 A and the coupling structures 203 on the upper surface of the second substrate 110 B are indicated by broken lines
- the coupling structures 204 on the lower surface of the second substrate 110 B and the coupling structures 205 on the upper surface of the third substrate 110 C are indicated by solid lines.
- pixel signal processing circuits are mounted around the pixel unit 206 of the first substrate 110 A. Therefore, pixel signals acquired by the pixel unit 206 are subjected to processing such as AD conversion by the pixel signal processing circuits on the first substrate 110 A, and then transmitted to a circuit included in the second substrate 110 B.
- the coupling structures 201 included in the I/O unit are also disposed around the pixel unit 206 of the first substrate 110 A of the first substrate 110 A. Therefore, as illustrated in FIG.
- the coupling structures 202 on the lower surface of the first substrate 110 A are disposed along the outer periphery of the chip in association with the regions where the pixel signal processing circuits and the I/O units exist in order to electrically couple the pixel signal processing circuits and the I/O units to the circuit included in the second substrate 110 B.
- the coupling structures 203 on the upper surface of the second substrate 110 B are also disposed accordingly along the outer periphery of the chip.
- a logic circuit or a memory circuit mounted on the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C may be formed on the entire surface of the chip.
- the coupling structures 204 on the lower surface of the second substrate 110 B and the coupling structures 205 on the upper surface of the third substrate 110 C are thus disposed over the entire surface of the chips in association with the position at which the logic circuit or the memory circuit is mounted, as illustrated in FIG. 2 B .
- FIGS. 2 C and 2 D are diagram for describing another example of the disposition of the coupling structures of the solid-state imaging device 1 in the horizontal plane.
- FIGS. 2 C and 2 D each illustrate the disposition of coupling structures in a case where, for example, the solid-state imaging device 1 is configured to be able to execute pixel ADC.
- a pixel signal processing circuit is mounted on not the first substrate 110 A, but the second substrate 110 B.
- FIG. 2 C schematically illustrates the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C included in the solid-state imaging device 1 .
- Electrical coupling between the lower surface (surface opposed to the second substrate 110 B) of the first substrate 110 A and the upper surface (surface opposed to the first substrate 110 A) of the second substrate 110 B through coupling structures is indicated by a broken line or a dotted line in a simulated manner
- electrical coupling between the lower surface (surface opposed to the third substrate 110 C) of the second substrate 110 B and the upper surface (surface opposed to the second substrate 110 B) of the third substrate 110 C through coupling structures is indicated by a solid line in a simulated manner.
- a broken line indicates electrical coupling related to an I/O unit, for example, which also exists in FIG. 2 A
- a dotted line indicates electrical coupling related to pixel ADC, which does not exist in FIG. 2 A .
- FIG. 2 D schematically illustrates the positions of coupling structures 202 on the lower surface of the first substrate 110 A, the positions of coupling structures 203 on the upper surface of the second substrate 110 B, the positions of coupling structures 204 on the lower surface of the second substrate 110 B, and the positions of coupling structures 205 on the upper surface of the third substrate 110 C.
- FIG. 2 D illustrates the coupling structures 202 to 205 in accordance with the forms of straight lines indicating electrical coupling illustrated in FIG. 2 C .
- the coupling structures 202 on the lower surface of the first substrate 110 A or the coupling structures 203 on the upper surface of the second substrate 110 B those that correspond to, for example, electrical coupling related to I/O units, which also exists in FIG. 2 A , are indicated by broken lines, and those that may correspond to electrical coupling related to pixel ADC are indicated by dotted lines.
- the coupling structures 204 on the lower surface of the second substrate 110 B and the coupling structures 205 on the upper surface of the third substrate 110 C are indicated by solid lines.
- a pixel signal processing circuit is mounted on the second substrate 110 B, and the pixel signal processing circuit is configured to be able to perform pixel ADC. That is, a pixel signal acquired by each pixel of the pixel unit 206 is transmitted to the pixel signal processing circuit mounted on the second substrate 110 B directly below for each pixel, and the pixel signal processing circuit performs processing such as AD conversion. As illustrated in FIGS.
- the coupling structures 202 on the lower surface of the first substrate 110 A are thus disposed along the outer periphery of the chip (coupling structures 202 indicated by the broken lines in the diagram) in association with the regions where the I/O units exist in order to transmit signals from the I/O units to the circuit included in the second substrate 110 B, and are disposed over the entire region where the pixel unit 206 exists (coupling structures 202 indicated by the dotted lines in the diagram) in order to transmit a pixel signal from each pixel of the pixel unit 206 to the circuit included in the second substrate 110 B.
- the respective signal lines of the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C are electrically coupled to each other, and the respective power supply lines of the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C are electrically coupled to each other similarly to the configuration examples illustrated in FIGS. 2 A and 2 B .
- the coupling structures 204 on the lower surface of the second substrate 110 B and the coupling structures 205 on the upper surface of the third substrate 110 C are thus disposed over the entire surface of the chips.
- FIGS. 2 E and 2 F are diagrams for describing still another example of the disposition of the coupling structures of the solid-state imaging device 1 in the horizontal plane.
- FIGS. 2 E and 2 F each illustrate the disposition of coupling structures in a case where, for example, a memory circuit is mounted on the second substrate 110 B.
- FIG. 2 E schematically illustrates the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C included in the solid-state imaging device 1 .
- Electrical coupling between the lower surface (surface opposed to the second substrate 110 B) of the first substrate 110 A and the upper surface (surface opposed to the first substrate 110 A) of the second substrate 110 B through coupling structures is indicated by a broken line or a dotted line in a simulated manner
- electrical coupling between the lower surface (surface opposed to the third substrate 110 C) of the second substrate 110 B and the upper surface (surface opposed to the second substrate 110 B) of the third substrate 110 C through coupling structures is indicated by a solid line or a dotted line in a simulated manner.
- a broken line indicates electrical coupling related to an I/O unit, for example, which also exists in FIG. 2 A
- a dotted line indicates electrical coupling related to a memory circuit, which does not exist in FIG. 2 A
- the solid lines indicate electrical coupling, which also exists in FIG. 2 A , related to signals that are not directly related to the operation of a memory circuit, for example
- the dotted lines indicate electrical coupling, which does not exist in FIG. 2 A , related to a memory circuit.
- FIG. 2 F schematically illustrates the positions of coupling structures 202 on the lower surface of the first substrate 110 A, the positions of coupling structures 203 on the upper surface of the second substrate 110 B, the positions of coupling structures 204 on the lower surface of the second substrate 110 B, and the positions of coupling structures 205 on the upper surface of the third substrate 110 C.
- FIG. 2 F illustrates the coupling structures 202 to 205 in accordance with the forms of straight lines indicating electrical coupling illustrated in FIG. 2 E .
- those that correspond to, for example, electrical coupling related to I/O units, which also exists in FIG. 2 A are indicated by broken lines, and those that may correspond to electrical coupling related to a memory circuit are indicated by dotted lines.
- those that correspond to electrical coupling, which exists in FIG. 2 A related to signals that are not directly related to the operation of a memory circuit, for example, are indicated by solid lines, and those that may correspond to electrical coupling related to a memory circuit are indicated by dotted lines.
- a memory circuit is mounted on the second substrate 110 B.
- a pixel signal processing circuit is mounted on the first substrate 110 A, and a pixel signal acquired by the pixel unit 206 and subjected to AD conversion by the pixel signal processing circuit of the first substrate 110 A may be transmitted to the memory circuit of the second substrate 110 B and held in the memory circuit.
- signals are then transmitted between the memory circuit of the second substrate 110 B and a logic circuit of the third substrate 110 C.
- the coupling structures 202 on the lower surface of the first substrate 110 A are disposed along the outer periphery of the chip (coupling structures 202 indicated by the broken lines in the diagram) in association with the regions where I/O units and pixel signal processing circuits are mounted in order to transmit signals from the I/O units and the pixel signal processing circuits to the second substrate 110 B, and the coupling structures 202 are disposed (coupling structures 202 indicated by the dotted lines in the diagram) for transmitting the pixel signals subjected to AD conversion to a memory circuit of the second substrate 110 B.
- the wiring lengths of the transmission paths of the pixel signals from the circuit of the first substrate 110 A to the memory circuit of the second substrate 110 B and the wiring lengths of the transmission paths of the signals between the memory circuit of the second substrate 110 B and a logic circuit of the third substrate 110 C be each equal as much as possible.
- the coupling structures 202 to 205 for exchanging signals between the circuit of the first substrate 110 A and the memory circuit of the second substrate 110 B and between the memory circuit of the second substrate 110 B and the circuit of the third substrate 110 C may be provided to concentrate in the vicinity of the middle of the horizontal plane.
- the coupling structures 202 to 205 do not necessarily have to be provided in the vicinity of the middle of the horizontal plane as in the illustrated example.
- the coupling structures 201 included in I/O units are disposed along three sides of the outer periphery of the chip, but the present embodiment is not limited to the examples. Various known disposition may also be applied as the disposition of I/O units.
- the coupling structures 201 included in I/O units may be disposed along one side, two sides, or four sides of the outer periphery of the chip.
- the solid-state imaging device 1 in the solid-state imaging device 1 , the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-F (i.e., the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B is opposed to the first substrate 110 A). Meanwhile, the solid-state imaging device 1 may include the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B that are bonded together F-to-B (i.e., the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B may be opposed to the third substrate 110 C).
- the direction of the second substrate 110 B may be determined as appropriate to improve the performance of the entire solid-state imaging device 1 by considering, for example, the configuration, performance, and the like of each of the substrates (each of the chips).
- two concepts for determining the direction of the second substrate 110 B are described as an example.
- FIG. 3 A is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device 1 in which the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-F, similarly to the configuration illustrated in FIG. 1 .
- FIG. 3 B is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device 1 a in which the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-B unlike the configuration illustrated in FIG. 1 .
- the configuration of the solid-state imaging device 1 a is similar to that of the solid-state imaging device 1 illustrated in FIG. 1 except that the direction of the second substrate 110 B is reversed.
- FIGS. 3 A and 3 B the functions (signal lines, GND wiring lines, or power supply wiring lines) of the respective wiring lines included in the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 are represented by superimposing different kinds of hatching on these wiring lines (i.e., the hatching of each wiring line illustrated in FIGS. 3 A and 3 B is expressed by superimposing the hatching representing the function of each wiring line illustrated in the respective legends in FIGS. 3 A and 3 B on the hatching of each wiring line illustrated in FIG. 1 (the same applies to FIGS. 4 A and 4 B described below)).
- terminals (corresponding to the pads 151 described above) for drawing out the signal lines, the GND wiring lines, and the power supply wiring lines to the outside are provided along the outer periphery of the chips. These respective terminals are provided in pairs at positions sandwiching the pixel unit 206 in the horizontal plane. Therefore, inside the solid-state imaging devices 1 and 1 a , the signal lines, the GND wiring lines, and the power supply wiring lines extend to couple these terminals to each other, and spread in the horizontal plane.
- the PDs included in the respective pixels of the pixel unit are PDs in which N-type diffused regions are formed in the PWELLs in order to read out an electron resulting from photoelectric conversion, and a transistor of a drive circuit included in each pixel in order to read out an electron generated in the PD is an N-type MOS transistor. Therefore, WELLs of the pixel unit are PWELLs.
- a logic circuit and a memory circuit provided to the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C include CMOS circuits, and PMOSs and NMOSs are thus mixed. Accordingly, PWELLs and NWELLs exist that are substantially the same in area, for example. Therefore, in the illustrated configuration example, the first substrate 110 A has a larger PWELL area than the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C.
- a ground potential may be imparted to a PWELL.
- any configuration in which a PWELL and a power supply wiring line are opposed to each other with an insulator interposed therebetween causes parasitic capacitance to be formed therebetween.
- FIG. 4 A is a diagram for describing the parasitic capacitance between a PWELL and a power supply wiring line in the solid-state imaging device 1 illustrated in FIG. 3 A .
- the parasitic capacitance between the PWELL and the power supply wiring line is represented by a two-dot chain line in a simulated manner with respect to the solid-state imaging device 1 illustrated in FIG. 3 A .
- the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-F.
- the PWELLs of the pixel unit of the first substrate 110 A and the power supply wiring lines in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B are therefore opposed to each other with insulators interposed therebetween as illustrated in the diagram.
- the insulators are included in the insulating films 103 and 123 . This may cause parasitic capacitance to be formed therebetween in the region.
- FIG. 4 B is a diagram for describing the parasitic capacitance between a PWELL and a power supply wiring line in the solid-state imaging device 1 a illustrated in FIG. 3 B .
- the parasitic capacitance between the PWELL and the power supply wiring line is represented by a two-dot chain line in a simulated manner with respect to the solid-state imaging device 1 a illustrated in FIG. 3 B .
- the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C are bonded together F-to-F.
- the PWELLs of the logic circuit or memory circuit of the third substrate 110 C and the power supply wiring lines in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B are therefore opposed to each other with insulators interposed therebetween as illustrated in the diagram.
- the insulators are included in the insulating films 123 and 133 . This may cause parasitic capacitance to be formed therebetween in the region.
- the parasitic capacitance described above is considered to increase as the PWELL area increases. This causes larger parasitic capacitance in the configuration illustrated in FIG. 4 A in which the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-F than in the configuration illustrated in FIG. 4 B in which the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-B among the configuration examples illustrated in FIGS. 4 A and 4 B .
- the parasitic capacitance related to the power supply wiring lines in the second substrate 110 B is large, the impedance of the current paths between the power supply and the GND in the second substrate 110 B is decreased. It is thus possible to further stabilize the power supply system in the second substrate 110 B. Specifically, for example, even in a case where the power consumption fluctuates in accordance with fluctuations in the operation of the circuits on the second substrate 110 B, fluctuations in the power supply levels caused by the fluctuations in the power consumption may be suppressed. Even in a case where the circuits related to the second substrate 110 B are operated at high speed, it is thus possible to further stabilize the operation, and improve the performance of the entire solid-state imaging device 1 .
- the solid-state imaging device 1 in which the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-F forms larger parasitic capacitance with respect to the power supply wiring lines of the second substrate 110 B than the solid-state imaging device 1 a in which the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-B does, making it possible to achieve higher stability at the time of high-speed operation. That is, it is possible to say that the solid-state imaging device 1 has a more preferable configuration.
- the respective substrates may, however, cause the third substrate 110 C to have a larger PWELL area than that of the first substrate 110 A.
- the configuration of the solid-state imaging device 1 a in which larger parasitic capacitance is formed between the power supply wiring lines of the second substrate 110 B and the PWELLs of the third substrate 110 C is considered to make it possible to obtain higher stability at the time of high-speed operation than the solid-state imaging device 1 does.
- the solid-state imaging device 1 be configured in a manner that the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B is opposed to the first substrate 110 A in a case where the PWELL area of the first substrate 110 A is larger than the PWELL area of the third substrate 110 C. That is, it is preferable that the solid-state imaging device 1 be configured in a manner that the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-F.
- the solid-state imaging device 1 a be configured in a manner that the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B is opposed to the third substrate 110 C in a case where the PWELL area of the third substrate 110 C is larger than the PWELL area of the first substrate 110 A. That is, it is preferable that the solid-state imaging device 1 a be configured in a manner that the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-B.
- the direction of the second substrate 110 B may be determined from such a viewpoint based on PWELL area.
- examples of a case where the PWELL area of the first substrate 110 A is larger than the PWELL area of the third substrate 110 C include a case where only a pixel unit including, in a PWELL, a PD for reading out an electron resulting from photoelectric conversion and an NMOS transistor for reading out an electron from the PD is mounted on the first substrate 110 A, and various circuits (such as a pixel signal processing circuit, a logic circuit, and a memory circuit) are mounted on the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C.
- examples of a case in which the PWELL area of the third substrate 110 C is larger than the PWELL area of the first substrate 110 A include a case in which a pixel unit and various circuits are mounted together on the first substrate 110 A and the area of the first substrate 110 A occupied by the various circuits is relatively large.
- FIG. 5 A is a diagram schematically illustrating the disposition of power supply wiring lines and GND wiring lines in the solid-state imaging device 1 illustrated in FIG. 3 A .
- FIG. 5 B is a diagram schematically illustrating the disposition of power supply wiring lines and GND wiring lines in the solid-state imaging device 1 a illustrated in FIG. 3 B .
- FIGS. 5 A and 5 B simply illustrate the structures of the solid-state imaging devices 1 and 1 a , and represent the schematic disposition of power supply wiring lines and GND wiring lines by illustrating the power supply wiring lines by two-dot chain lines and illustrating the GND wiring lines by one-dot chain lines.
- the size of the arrows in the diagrams represents the amount of currents flowing through the power supply wiring lines and the GND wiring lines in a simulated manner.
- the power supply wiring lines mainly include vertical power supply wiring lines 303 extending in the z-axis direction from power supply terminals (VCCs) provided to the upper surface of the first substrate 110 A (i.e., upper surfaces of the solid-state imaging devices 1 and 1 a ), and horizontal power supply wiring lines 304 extending in the horizontal direction in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C.
- VCCs power supply terminals
- the horizontal power supply wiring lines 304 may also exist actually in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, but are not illustrated in FIGS. 5 A and 5 B for the sake of simplicity.
- FIGS. 5 A and 5 B each illustrate only the horizontal power supply wiring line 304 in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C.
- the GND wiring lines mainly include vertical GND wiring lines 305 extending in the z-axis direction from GND terminals provided to the upper surface of the first substrate 110 A, and horizontal GND wirings 306 extending in the horizontal direction in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C.
- the following also refers collectively to the vertical GND wiring lines 305 and the horizontal GND wiring lines 306 as GND wiring lines 305 and 306 .
- the horizontal GND wiring line 306 of the first substrate 110 A is also referred to as horizontal GND wiring line 306 a
- the horizontal GND wiring line 306 of the second substrate 110 B is also referred to as horizontal GND wiring line 306 b
- the horizontal GND wiring line 306 of the third substrate 110 C is also referred to as horizontal GND wiring line 306 c to distinguish them.
- the third substrate 110 C is a logic substrate.
- the logic circuit is divided into a plurality of circuit blocks, and the circuit blocks that operate may change depending on processing content. That is, during a series of operations in the solid-state imaging devices 1 and 1 a , the locations of the logic circuit that mainly operate may change. Therefore, the locations of the logic circuit through which the power supply currents flow are biased (e.g., the power supply currents are generated due to the charging and discharging of the transistor gate capacitance and the wiring capacitance associated with the operation of the circuit), and moreover the locations may change.
- the power consumption of the circuit block 301 at certain timing is greater than that of the circuit block 302 .
- more currents are supplied at this timing from the power supply wiring lines 303 and 304 to the circuit block 301 than to the circuit block 302 .
- This difference in power consumption causes the vertical GND wiring line 305 (that is also referred to as vertical GND wiring line 305 a to distinguish the vertical GND wiring lines 305 ) near the circuit block 301 to have a larger amount of currents flowing to the vertical GND wiring line 305 through the circuit blocks 301 and 302 than that of the vertical GND wiring line 305 (that is also referred to as vertical GND wiring 305 b to distinguish the vertical GND wiring lines 305 ) near the circuit block 302 .
- the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B include the horizontal GND wiring lines 306 a and 306 b , and the imbalance of the amount of currents between the vertical GND wiring lines 305 a and 305 b is thus corrected by the horizontal GND wiring lines 306 a and 306 b of the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B on the way to the GND terminals on the upper surface of the first substrate 110 A. That is, currents flow to the horizontal GND wiring lines 306 a and 306 b of the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to correct the imbalance of the amount of currents between the vertical GND wiring lines 305 a and 305 b . Accordingly, as illustrated by the solid-line arrows in each of FIGS.
- a loop-shaped current path passing by the horizontal power supply wiring line 304 , the circuit blocks 301 and 302 , the horizontal GND wiring line 306 c , the vertical GND wiring line 305 a , and the horizontal GND wiring lines 306 a and 306 b is formed in each of the solid-state imaging devices 1 and 1 a.
- the horizontal GND wiring lines 306 a and 306 b of the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are both disposed relatively far from the horizontal power supply wiring line 304 of the third substrate 110 C. Therefore, in the loop-shaped current path described above, the opening width of the loop is increased. This increases the inductance of the loop-shaped current path. That is, the impedance becomes high. The stability of the power supply currents may be thus decreased, and the performance of the entire solid-state imaging device 1 may be decreased.
- the horizontal GND wiring line 306 a of the first substrate 110 A is disposed relatively far from the horizontal power supply wiring line 304 of the third substrate 110 C, but the horizontal GND wiring line 306 b of the second substrate 110 B is disposed relatively close to the horizontal power supply wiring line 304 of the third substrate 110 C. Therefore, in the loop-shaped current path described above, the opening width of the loop is decreased. This decreases the inductance of the loop-shaped current path. That is, the impedance becomes low. It is thus possible to further stabilize the power supply currents, and further improve the performance of the entire solid-state imaging device 1 .
- the solid-state imaging device 1 a in which the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-B is considered to achieve a more stable operation than the solid-state imaging device 1 in which the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-F does in a case where the power consumption of the third substrate 110 C is greater than the power consumption of the first substrate 110 A.
- the solid-state imaging device 1 a allows the horizontal GND wiring line 306 b of the second substrate 110 B to be disposed closer to the horizontal power supply wiring line 304 of the third substrate 110 C. That is, it is possible to say that the solid-state imaging device 1 a has a more preferable configuration.
- Some designs of the respective substrates may, however, cause the first substrate 110 A to consume more power than the third substrate 110 C does. In this case, a more stable operation is considered expectable from the configuration of the solid-state imaging device 1 that allows the distance to be decreased between the horizontal power supply wiring line of the first substrate 110 A and the horizontal ground wiring line 306 b of the second substrate 110 B rather than the solid-state imaging device 1 a.
- the solid-state imaging device 1 be configured in a manner that the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B is opposed to the first substrate 110 A in a case where the power consumption of the first substrate 110 A is greater than the power consumption of the third substrate 110 C. That is, it is preferable that the solid-state imaging device 1 be configured in a manner that the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-F.
- the solid-state imaging device 1 a be configured in a manner that the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B is opposed to the third substrate 110 C in a case where the power consumption of the third substrate 110 C is larger than the power consumption of the first substrate 110 A. That is, it is preferable that the solid-state imaging device 1 a be configured in a manner that the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-B.
- the direction of the second substrate 110 B may be determined from such a viewpoint based on the power consumption and the disposition of GND wiring lines.
- examples of a case where the power consumption of the third substrate 110 C is greater than the power consumption of the first substrate 110 A include a case where only a pixel unit is mounted on the first substrate 110 A and many circuits (such as a pixel signal processing circuit, a logic circuit, and a memory circuit, for example) are mounted on the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C.
- Specific examples of such a configuration include a configuration in which only a pixel unit is mounted on the first substrate 110 A, a pixel signal processing circuit and a memory circuit are mounted on the second substrate 110 B, and a logic circuit is mounted on the third substrate 110 C.
- a digital circuit (such as a digital circuit that, for example, generates a reference voltage for AD conversion) in the pixel signal processing circuit may be mounted on the third substrate 110 C.
- a memory circuit that is more frequently accessed e.g., memory circuit into or from which pixel signals are written or read out only a plurality of times per frame
- the third substrate 110 C is considered to consume more power.
- examples of a case in which the power consumption of the first substrate 110 A is greater than the power consumption of the third substrate 110 C include a case in which a pixel unit and various circuits are mounted together on the first substrate 110 A and the area of the first substrate 110 A occupied by the various circuits is relatively large.
- the third substrate 110 C is considered to consume less power and the first substrate 110 A is considered to relatively consume more power.
- the power consumption itself may be compared, or other indices that may represent the magnitude of the power consumption may be compared.
- the other indices include the number of gates (e.g., 100 gates and 1 M gates) mounted on the circuits of each substrate, the operating frequencies (e.g., 100 MHz and 1 GHz) of the circuits of each substrate, and the like.
- FIG. 5 C is a diagram illustrating a configuration example for decreasing impedance in the solid-state imaging device 1 illustrated in FIG. 5 A .
- 5 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 1 illustrated in FIG. 5 A in which the horizontal GND wiring line 306 a of the first substrate 110 A and the horizontal GND wiring line 306 b of the second substrate 110 B are coupled to each other by using a plurality of vertical GND wiring lines, and the other components are similar to those of the solid-state imaging device 1 .
- FIG. 5 C illustrates, as an example, a configuration that may allow the impedance of the loop-shaped current path to be decreased in a case where the power consumption of the third substrate 110 C is greater than the power consumption of the first substrate 110 A, and the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-F.
- the horizontal GND wiring line 306 b of the second substrate 110 B and the horizontal GND wiring line 306 c of the third substrate 110 C are coupled to each other by using a plurality of vertical GND wiring lines in order to decrease the impedance of the loop-shaped current path in a case where the power consumption of the first substrate 110 A is greater than the power consumption of the third substrate 110 C, and the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B are bonded together F-to-B.
- the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B have to be provided with coupling structures for coupling the GND wiring lines thereof to each other.
- This imposes a constraint that takes into consideration the coupling structures to be provided on the disposition of the GND wiring lines and the disposition of the other wiring lines in the multi-layered wiring layers 105 and 125 .
- the vertical GND wiring lines and the coupling structures for coupling the vertical GND wiring lines between the substrates to each other are distributed not only in the outer peripheral portions of the chips, but also more in the middle portions of the chips in the horizontal plane.
- the respective wiring lines thus have to be disposed by taking this distribution into consideration. That is, the degree of flexibility in designing the respective wiring lines in the multi-layered wiring layers 105 and 125 is decreased.
- the impedance of the loop-shaped current path is decreased by adjusting the direction of the second substrate 110 B.
- This makes it possible, unlike the configuration illustrated in FIG. 5 C , to dispose vertical GND wiring lines to distribute more vertical GND wiring lines in the outer peripheral portions of the chips in the horizontal plane. It is thus possible to decrease the impedance in the current path without decreasing the degree of flexibility in designing the wiring lines in the multi-layered wiring layers 105 and 125 . That is, it is possible to stabilize the operations of the solid-state imaging devices 1 and 1 a.
- the density of the vertical GND wiring lines disposed in the outer peripheral portions of the chips and in the middle portions of the chips in the horizontal plane for example, as follows. For example, in a case where the number of vertical GND wiring lines existing in the one middle region of nine regions obtained by equally dividing a chip as a 3 ⁇ 3 region in the horizontal plane is larger than the number of vertical GND wiring lines existing in the eight peripheral regions, it is possible to determine that the number of vertical GND wiring lines in the middle portion of the chip is large (i.e., it is possible to determine that the configuration of the solid-state imaging device 1 b illustrated in FIG. 5 C may be possibly applied).
- the number of regions obtained by dividing a chip is not limited to the example.
- the number of regions obtained by dividing a chip may be changed as appropriate into the 16 regions of a 4 ⁇ 4 region, the 25 regions of a 5 ⁇ 5 region, or the like. It is sufficient if, for example, in a case where a chip is divided into 16 regions as a 4 ⁇ 4 region, the density is determined from the number of vertical GND wiring lines in the four middle regions and the 12 peripheral regions.
- the density is determined from the number of vertical GND wiring lines in the one middle region and the 24 peripheral regions, or in the nine middle regions and the 16 peripheral regions.
- the configuration of the solid-state imaging device 1 illustrated in FIG. 1 is an example of a solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may include a coupling structure different from a coupling structure illustrated in FIG. 1 .
- Another configuration example of the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment in which a different coupling structure is included is now described. Note that the components of the respective solid-state imaging devices described below correspond to the components of the solid-state imaging device 1 illustrated in FIG. 1 in which a portion of the components is changed. The components that have already been described with reference to FIG. 1 are not thus described in detail.
- each of the diagrams illustrating a schematic configuration of each solid-state imaging device described below does not have a portion of the reference numerals attached in FIG. 1 in order to avoid complicating the diagram.
- FIG. 1 and each of the subsequent diagrams illustrate that members having the same type of hatching include the same material.
- the solid-state imaging device is provided with at least the shared contact type TSV 157 like the solid-state imaging device 1 illustrated in FIG. 1 .
- the shared contact refers to a via having a structure in which an electrically-conductive material is embedded in one through hole provided to expose, while exposing a portion of a predetermined wiring line in one substrate, a predetermined wiring line in another substrate, or a structure in which a film including an electrically-conductive material is formed on the inner wall of the through hole.
- the shared contact type TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A
- a through hole is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A for two wiring lines having an equal electric potential disposed side by side at a predetermined interval in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, and a wiring line positioned immediately below a space between the two wiring lines having an equal electric potential in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B.
- the through hole has a diameter larger than that of the space between the two wiring lines having an equal electric potential, and is formed from immediately above the two wiring lines having an equal electric potential by dry etching. At this time, the through hole having the large diameter is formed to prevent the two wiring lines having an equal electric potential from being exposed.
- a through hole having a diameter smaller than that of the space between the two wiring lines having an equal electric potential is formed to expose the wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B positioned immediately below the space between the two wiring lines having an equal electric potential.
- the through hole having the large diameter is grown by etch-back, thereby exposing a portion of the two wiring lines having an equal electric potential in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A.
- the through hole has a shape in which the wiring line positioned immediately below the space between the two wiring lines in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B is exposed while a portion of the two wiring lines having an equal electric potential in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A is exposed.
- an electrically-conductive material is embedded in the through hole, or a film including an electrically-conductive material is formed on the inner wall of the through hole, which makes it possible to form the shared contact type TSV 157 .
- the dry etching is not performed on the two wiring lines having an equal electric potential to form the through hole having the large diameter and the through hole having the small diameter, which makes it possible to suppress a situation in which corners of the two wiring lines having an equal electric potential are shaved and occurrence of contamination. Therefore, the solid-state imaging device 1 with higher reliability may be achieved.
- the through hole is provided to pass through the space between two wiring lines disposed side by side with a predetermined interval, but, for example, a ring-shaped wiring line having an opening may be formed, and the through hole may be provided to pass through the opening of the wiring line.
- the shared contact type TSV 157 by a method different from the method described above.
- the shared contact type TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A
- the dry etching may be continued as it is without stopping the dry etching in the middle to prevent the two wiring lines having an equal electric potential from being exposed, while exposing a portion of the two wiring lines having an equal electric potential.
- the through hole has a shape in which the wiring line positioned immediately below the space between the two wiring lines in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B is exposed while a portion of the two wiring lines in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A is exposed.
- An electrically-conductive material is embedded in the through hole formed in such a way, or a film including an electrically-conductive material is formed on the inner wall of the through hole, which may form the shared contact type TSV 157 .
- the shared contact type TSV 157 does not necessarily have to be provided to pass through the space between the two wiring lines having an equal electric potential or the opening of the ring-shaped wiring line.
- the number of wiring lines positioned in an upper layer in a case where the through hole is formed, may be one.
- the through hole may be formed to have a shape in which the wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B is exposed while a portion of one wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A is exposed.
- an electrically-conductive material is embedded in the through hole, or a film including an electrically-conductive material is formed on the inner wall of the through hole, which may form the shared contact type TSV 157 .
- there is one wiring line in the upper layer which causes a concern that the through hole is formed without exposing the wiring line in the upper layer due to, for example, misalignment or the like, as compared with a case where the number of wiring lines in the upper layer is two, or a case where the wiring line in the upper layer has a ring shape having an opening, and a contact defect is thus likely to occur.
- the mode in which the number of wiring lines is one be applied to a case where it is possible to have a margin enough for overlap between the through hole and the one wiring line to be able to ensure contactability between the TSV 157 and the one wiring line.
- the solid-state imaging device may be further provided, between the substrates including the respective signal lines that are not electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 described above and the respective power supply lines that are not electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 described above, with another coupling structure for electrically coupling these signal lines to each other and electrically coupling these power supply lines to each other.
- the solid-state imaging device is classified into 20 categories according to the specific configurations of these coupling structures.
- a first configuration example ( FIGS. 6 A, 6 B, 6 C, 6 D, 6 E, 6 F, 6 G, 6 H, 6 I, 6 J, 6 K, 6 L , and 6 M) is a configuration example in which the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 is provided as a coupling structure for electrically coupling the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically coupling the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other, but the twin contact type or shared contact type TSV 157 described below, or the electrode junction structure 159 described below does not exist in addition to the TSV 157 .
- the two-layer TSV refers to a TSV provided to allow the respective signal lines included in two adjacent substrates out of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to be electrically coupled to each other and allow the respective power supply lines included in the two adjacent substrates to be electrically coupled to each other.
- the TSV 157 and the electrode junction structures 159 are not provided in addition to the TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C are electrically coupled to each other and the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C are electrically coupled to each other, and/or the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C are electrically coupled to each other and the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C are coupled to each other through the I/O unit.
- the solid-state imaging device includes, as another coupling structure, the pad 151 that may electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other, and/or the pad 151 that may electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other, together with the TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the solid-state imaging device 1 illustrated in FIG. 1 is also included in the first configuration example.
- a second configuration example ( FIGS. 7 A, 7 B, 7 C, and 7 D ) is a configuration example in which at least the twin contact type two-layer TSV 157 described below is provided as a coupling structure for electrically coupling the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically coupling the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other, together with the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 .
- the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the twin contact refers to a via having a structure in which electrically-conductive materials are embedded in a first through hole that exposes a predetermined wiring line and a second through hole that is different from the first through hole and exposes another wiring line different from the predetermined wiring line, or a structure in which films including electrically-conductive materials are formed on the inner walls of the first through hole and the second through hole.
- a third configuration example ( FIGS. 8 A, 8 B, 8 C, 8 D, 8 E, and 8 F ) is a configuration example in which at least the twin contact type three-layer TSV 157 described below is provided as a coupling structure, together with the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 .
- the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the three-layer TSV refers to a TSV extending over all of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C.
- the twin contact type three-layer TSV 157 formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C may structurally couple electrically the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other, or electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- twin contact type three-layer TSV 157 formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A may structurally couple electrically the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other, or electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a fourth configuration example is a configuration example in which at least the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 is further provided as a coupling structure for electrically coupling the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically coupling the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other, together with the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 .
- the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- a fifth configuration example ( FIGS. 10 A, 10 B, 10 C, 10 D, 10 E, and 10 F ) is a configuration example in which at least the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 described below is provided as a coupling structure, together with the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 .
- the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 may structurally couple electrically the respective signal lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the diagrams may have the plurality of twin contact type or shared contact type TSVs 157 to describe the second to fifth configuration examples, and seventh to tenth configuration examples, twelfth to fifteenth configuration examples, and seventeenth to twentieth configuration examples, which are described below.
- the plurality of these TSVs 157 is distinguished by attaching different alphabets to the end of the reference numeral like TSV 157 a , TSV 157 b, . . . .
- FIGS. 11 A, 11 B, 11 C, 11 D, and 11 E is a configuration example in which at least the electrode junction structure 159 described below is provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C as a coupling structure for electrically coupling the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically coupling the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other, together with the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 .
- the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 means a structure in which the electrodes formed on the respective bonding surfaces of the two substrates are joined in direct contact with each other.
- the seventh configuration example ( FIGS. 12 A, 12 B, 12 C, and 12 D ) is a configuration example in which at least the electrode junction structure 159 described below between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the twin contact type two-layer TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other are provided as coupling structures, together with the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 .
- the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the twin contact type two-layer TSV 157 is described below.
- the eighth configuration example ( FIGS. 13 A, 13 B, 13 C, 13 D, 13 E, and 13 F ) is a configuration example in which at least the electrode junction structure 159 described below between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the twin contact type three-layer TSV 157 described below are provided as coupling structures, together with the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 .
- the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the ninth configuration example ( FIGS. 14 A, 14 B, 14 C, and 14 D ) is a configuration example in which at least the electrode junction structure 159 described below between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the further shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other are provided as coupling structures, together with the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 .
- the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the tenth configuration example ( FIGS. 15 A, 15 B, 15 C, 15 E, and 15 F ) is a configuration example in which at least the electrode junction structure 159 described below between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 described below are provided as coupling structures, together with the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 .
- the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- FIGS. 16 A, 16 B, 16 C, 16 D, 16 E, and 16 F is a configuration example in which the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 is provided as a coupling structure, but the twin contact type or shared contact type TSV 157 described below, or the electrode junction structure 159 described below does not exist in addition to the TSV 157 .
- the signal lines are electrically coupled to each other and the power supply lines are electrically coupled to each other through the I/O unit between the substrates including the respective signal lines that are not electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the respective power supply lines that are not electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 .
- the pad 151 is provided to each of the substrates including the respective signal lines that are not electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the respective power supply lines that are not electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 as another coupling structure together with the TSV 157 .
- the twelfth configuration example ( FIGS. 17 A, 17 B, 17 C, 17 D, and 17 E ) is a configuration example in which at least the twin contact type two-layer TSV 157 described below is provided as a coupling structure for electrically coupling the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically coupling the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other, together with the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 .
- the thirteenth configuration example ( FIGS. 18 A, 18 B, 18 C, 18 D, 18 E, 18 F, 18 G, 18 H, 18 I, and 18 J ) is a configuration example in which at least the twin contact type three-layer TSV 157 described below is provided as a coupling structure, together with the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 .
- the fourteenth configuration example ( FIGS. 19 A, 19 B, 19 C, 19 D, and 19 E ) is a configuration example in which at least the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 is provided as a coupling structure for electrically coupling the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically coupling the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other, together with the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 .
- the fifteenth configuration example ( FIGS. 20 A, 20 B, 20 C, 20 D, 20 E, and 20 F ) is a configuration example in which at least the further shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 is provided as a coupling structure, together with the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 .
- FIGS. 21 A, 21 B, 21 C, 21 D, 21 E, and 21 F is a configuration example in which at least the electrode junction structure 159 described below is provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C as a coupling structure for electrically coupling the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically coupling the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other, together with the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 .
- the seventeenth configuration example ( FIGS. 22 A, 22 B, 22 C, 22 D, and 22 E ) is a configuration example in which at least the electrode junction structure 159 described below between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the twin contact type two-layer TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other are provided as coupling structures, together with the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 .
- the twin contact type two-layer TSV 157 is described below.
- the eighteenth configuration example ( FIGS. 23 A, 23 B, 23 C, 23 D, 23 E, 23 F, 23 G, 23 H, 23 I, and 23 J ) is a configuration example in which at least the electrode junction structure 159 described below between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the twin contact type three-layer TSV 157 described below are provided as coupling structures, together with the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 .
- the nineteenth configuration example ( FIGS. 24 A, 24 B . 24 C, 24 D, and 24 E) is a configuration example in which at least the electrode junction structure 159 described below between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other are provided as coupling structures, together with the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 .
- the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 is described below.
- the twentieth configuration example ( FIGS. 25 A, 25 B, 25 C, 25 D, and 25 E ) is a configuration example in which at least the electrode junction structure 159 described below between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the further shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 are provided as coupling structures, together with the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 .
- the first to twentieth configuration examples are described in order.
- the configurations illustrated in the following respective diagrams do not mean that the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment has only the illustrated coupling structures, but the solid-state imaging device may appropriately have a coupling structure other than the illustrated coupling structures.
- the first metal wiring layer is, for example, a Cu wiring layer
- the second metal wiring layer is, for example, an Al wiring layer.
- FIGS. 6 A, 6 B, 6 C, 6 D, 6 E, 6 F, 6 G, 6 H, 6 I, 6 J, 6 K, 6 L, and 6 M is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the first configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 6 A, 6 B, 6 C, 6 D, 6 E, 6 F, 6 G, 6 H, 6 I, 6 J, 6 K, 6 L, and 6 M .
- a solid-state imaging device 2 a illustrated in FIG. 6 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 , the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, the pad opening 153 a that exposes the pad 151 , the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C, and the pad opening 153 b that exposes the pad 151 .
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the pads 151 , and the pad openings 153 a and 153 b may electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other, and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 2 b illustrated in FIG. 6 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 2 a illustrated in FIG. 6 A in which a substrate provided with the pad 151 is changed and the type (material) of wiring lines electrically coupled by the TSV 157 and the structure of the TSV 157 are changed.
- the solid-state imaging device 2 b illustrated in FIG. 6 B includes the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, the pad opening 153 a that exposes the pad 151 , the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C, and the pad opening 153 b that exposes the pad 151 .
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 is electrically coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer positioned at height different from that of the configuration illustrated in FIG. 6 A in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A.
- a solid-state imaging device 2 c illustrated in FIG. 6 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 2 a illustrated in FIG. 6 A in which the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 2 d illustrated in FIG. 6 D includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 , the lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 .
- the lead line opening 155 draws out a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C.
- the pad 151 is disposed on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A and electrically coupled to the predetermined wiring line by the electrically-conductive material included in the lead line opening 155 .
- the lead line opening 155 is an opening for drawing out a predetermined wiring line in any of the substrates 110 A, 110 B, and 110 C (in the illustrated example, a predetermined wiring line in the third substrate 110 C) to the outside.
- the lead line opening 155 has a structure in which a film including an electrically-conductive material (e.g., W) is formed on the inner wall of an opening formed to expose a wiring line to be drawn out. This film including the electrically-conductive material extends from the inside of the lead line opening 155 onto the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A as illustrated in the diagram.
- an electrically-conductive material e.g., W
- the pad 151 is formed on this extended film including the electrically-conductive material, and is electrically coupled to the wiring line in the substrate drawn out by the lead line opening 155 by the film including the electrically-conductive material.
- the lead line opening 155 is configured to draw out a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C.
- the electrically-conductive material of the film formed on the inner wall of the opening in the lead line opening 155 is not limited to W, but any of various known electrically-conductive materials may be used as the electrically-conductive material.
- this specification also refers, as lead pad structure, to the structure in which the pad 151 disposed on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A is electrically coupled to the wiring line drawn out by the lead line opening 155 .
- this specification also refers to the structure in which each of the pad openings 153 a and 153 b is provided to the pad 151 formed in the substrate as illustrated in FIG. 6 A , for example, as embedded pad structure (the structure illustrated in FIG. 1 is also an embedded pad structure) in contrast to the lead pad structure.
- the lead pad structure is a structure in which the pad 151 formed in the substrate in the embedded pad structure is drawn out to the outside of the substrate (onto the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A).
- the plurality of these lead line openings 155 is distinguished by attaching different alphabets to the end of the reference numeral like lead line opening 155 a , lead line opening 155 b , . . . for the sake of convenience.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 illustrated in FIG. 6 D does not include the first metal embedded inside a through hole, but includes a film including an electrically-conductive material and formed on the inner wall of the through hole.
- a film including the same material (e.g., W) as the electrically-conductive material included in the lead line opening 155 is formed as the electrically-conductive material.
- the TSV 157 having a configuration in which an electrically-conductive material is embedded in a through hole as illustrated in FIGS.
- the TSV 157 having a configuration in which a film including an electrically-conductive material is formed on the inner wall of a through hole as illustrated in FIG. 6 D may be used.
- the electrically-conductive material of the film formed on the inner wall of the through hole in the TSV 157 is not limited to W, but any of various known electrically-conductive materials may be used as the electrically-conductive material.
- the electrically-conductive material included in the TSV 157 may be different from the electrically-conductive material included in the lead line opening 155 .
- this specification also refers, as embedded TSV 157 , to the TSV 157 having a configuration in which an electrically-conductive material is embedded in a through hole as illustrated in FIGS. 6 A, 6 B, and 6 C .
- the TSV 157 having a configuration in which a film including an electrically-conductive material is formed on the inner wall of a through hole as illustrated in FIG. 6 D is also referred to as non-embedded TSV 157 .
- a solid-state imaging device 2 e illustrated in FIG. 6 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 2 a illustrated in FIG. 6 A in which the configurations of the TSV 157 and the lead line opening 155 are changed.
- the film including the electrically-conductive material included in the TSV 157 and the film including the electrically-conductive material included in the lead line opening 155 are not in contact with each other (i.e., no electrical continuity is established therebetween).
- both films are, however, in contact with each other and electrical continuity is established therebetween.
- a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C and the pad 151 provided on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A are electrically coupled to each other through the lead line opening 155 .
- This may cause the TSV 157 and the pad 151 (i.e., a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B electrically coupled by the TSV 157 , and the pad 151 ) to be electrically coupled to each other.
- the illustrated TSV 157 has a function of a TSV that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other, and a function of the lead line opening 155 that draws out a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A.
- TSV/lead line opening to a structure having both the function of the TSV 157 and the function of the lead line opening 155 like the TSV 157 illustrated in FIG.
- FIG. 6 E It is possible to say that the configuration illustrated in FIG. 6 E is a configuration in which the TSV/lead line openings 157 and 155 a , and the lead line opening 155 b are included as coupling structures. Note that each of the following diagrams refrains from describing the reference numeral “ 157 ” indicating a TSV, but attaches only the reference numeral “ 155 ” indicating a lead line opening to the TSV/lead line opening to avoid complication of the diagram.
- a solid-state imaging device 2 f illustrated in FIG. 6 F corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 2 e illustrated in FIG. 6 E in which the configurations of the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the lead line opening 155 b are changed.
- a wiring line drawn out by the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and a wiring line drawn out by the lead line opening 155 b are electrically coupled to the same pad 151 , but in the configuration illustrated in FIG. 6 F , a wiring line drawn out by the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and a wiring line drawn out by the lead line opening 155 b are electrically coupled to the pads 151 different from each other. That is, on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A, the plurality of respective pads 151 is provided in association with the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the lead line opening 155 b.
- a solid-state imaging device 2 g illustrated in FIG. 6 G corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 2 d illustrated in FIG. 6 D in which the structure of the TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 is electrically coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer positioned at height different from that of the configuration illustrated in FIG. 6 D in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A.
- a solid-state imaging device 2 h illustrated in FIG. 6 H corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 2 e illustrated in FIG. 6 E in which the structure of the TSV/lead line opening 155 a is changed.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 a is electrically coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer positioned at height different from that of the configuration illustrated in FIG. 6 E in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A.
- a solid-state imaging device 2 i illustrated in FIG. 6 I corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 2 f illustrated in FIG. 6 F in which the structure of the TSV/lead line opening 155 a is changed.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 a is electrically coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer positioned at height different from that of the configuration illustrated in FIG. 6 F in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A.
- a solid-state imaging device 2 j illustrated in FIG. 6 J corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 2 a illustrated in FIG. 6 A in which the embedded lead pad structure is changed to a lead pad structure.
- the pad 151 is formed on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A similarly to the above-described lead pad structure illustrated in FIG. 6 D and the like, but the pad 151 is then formed on an electrically-conductive material film 501 extended in the first substrate 110 A for other purposes.
- the embedded TSV 157 is then formed to bring the upper end of the embedded TSV 157 into contact with the electrically-conductive material film 501 .
- the TSV 157 and the pad 151 are electrically coupled to each other through the electrically-conductive material film 501 (i.e., a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 , and the pad 151 are electrically coupled to each other).
- the electrically-conductive material film 501 i.e., a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 , and the pad 151 are electrically coupled to each other.
- a light-shielding film including a metal material and having openings in portions corresponding to respective pixels may be provided between a CF and the back surface of the semiconductor substrate 101 (i.e., between the CF and the PD of a diffusion layer of the semiconductor substrate 101 ) (the pixels are two-dimensionally arranged; therefore, the metal material included in the light-shielding film exists only between the pixels, i.e., exists in the shape of a grid in the pixel unit).
- W may be used as the metal material.
- the metal material included in the light-shielding film is extended to a position of the outer periphery of the chip where the I/O unit is formed, and functions as the electrically-conductive material film 501 described above.
- a resin film 503 including a resin material having insulating properties is formed on the electrically-conductive material film 501 (i.e., the light-shielding film) in a region other than the pixel unit not to expose the electrically-conductive material film 501 .
- the pad 151 is formed to be embedded in the resin film 503 with the bottom thereof in contact with the electrically-conductive material film 501 as illustrated in the diagram.
- the material of the resin film 503 is not limited, but, for example, the resin film 503 may be formed using the same material as that of the CF. In this case, it is possible to form the resin film 503 simultaneously with the CF layer 111 , which makes it possible to simplify the process.
- a solid-state imaging device 2 k illustrated in FIG. 6 K corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 2 j illustrated in FIG. 6 J in which a lead pad structure using the lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the lead pad structure using the embedded TSV 157 .
- the lead pad structure has a configuration similar to the configuration illustrated in FIG. 6 J in which a wiring line drawn out by the lead line opening 155 and the pad 151 are electrically coupled to each other through the electrically-conductive material film 501 .
- the electrically-conductive material included in the lead line opening 155 is extended on the electrically-conductive material film 501 to come into contact with the electrically-conductive material film 501 , and the pad 151 is formed on the film including the extended electrically-conductive material.
- the resin film 503 is formed on the electrically-conductive material film 501 . This causes the lead pad structure illustrated in FIG. 6 K to have a structure in which the electrically-conductive material included in the lead line opening 155 , and the pad are embedded in the resin film 503 as illustrated in the diagram.
- this specification also refers to the lead pad structure in which the pad 151 is embedded in a film on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A as illustrated in FIGS. 6 J and 6 K as embedded lead pad structure.
- the embedded lead pad structure also includes a structure in which the pad 151 is embedded in the insulating film 109 like the configuration illustrated in FIG. 7 D described below.
- the lead pad structure in which the pad 151 is disposed without being embedded in a film on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A as illustrated in FIGS. 6 D, 6 E, 6 F, 6 G, 6 H, and 6 I is also accordingly referred to as non-embedded lead pad structure.
- a solid-state imaging device 21 illustrated in FIG. 6 L corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 2 j illustrated in FIG. 6 J in which the structure of the TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 is electrically coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer positioned at height different from that of the configuration illustrated in FIG. 6 J in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A.
- a solid-state imaging device 2 m illustrated in FIG. 6 M corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 2 j illustrated in FIG. 6 J in which an embedded lead pad structure using the lead line opening 155 is added and the structure of the TSV 157 is changed.
- an embedded lead pad structure using the lead line opening 155 is further provided to the configuration illustrated in FIG. 6 J , thereby providing the pad 151 to each of the embedded TSV 157 and the lead line opening 155 .
- the pad 151 is formed by being embedded in the resin film 503 .
- similarly to the configuration illustrated in FIG. 6 K in the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 is electrically coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer positioned at height different from that of the configuration illustrated in FIG. 6 K in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A.
- embedded pad structures and/or lead pad structures are provided to the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C, or the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C. These structures may electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and/or electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other through the pad 151 .
- the embedded pad structure and/or the lead pad structure is provided to the first substrate 110 A and/or the second substrate 110 B.
- These structures may electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and/or electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other through the pad 151 .
- the type of wiring line to which the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 is coupled is not limited in the respective configurations illustrated in FIGS. 6 A, 6 B, 6 C, 6 D, 6 E, 6 F, 6 G, 6 H, 6 I, 6 J, 6 K, 6 L, and 6 M .
- the TSV 157 may be coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer or may be coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- FIGS. 7 A, 7 B, 7 C, and 7 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the second configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 7 A, 7 B, 7 C, and 7 D .
- a solid-state imaging device 3 a illustrated in FIG. 7 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 a , the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 b , and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 3 b illustrated in FIG. 7 B includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSVs 157 a and 157 b , the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 c , and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the solid-state imaging device 3 b corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 3 a illustrated in FIG. 7 A in which the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 b is additionally provided (the TSVs 157 a and 157 c in FIG. 7 B respectively correspond to the TSVs 157 a and 157 b in FIG. 7 A ).
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is then formed to reach the upper end of the twin contact type two-layer TSV 157 c provided in the second substrate 110 B while penetrating a predetermined wiring line (in the illustrated example, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer) in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A.
- the TSV 157 b is formed to electrically couple a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and the TSV 157 c to each other. Further, the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and the predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the third substrate 110 C are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 c.
- a solid-state imaging device 3 c illustrated in FIG. 7 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 3 a illustrated in FIG. 7 A in which the shared contact type two-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the solid-state imaging device 3 c illustrated in FIG. 7 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 3 a illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 3 d illustrated in FIG. 7 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 3 c illustrated in FIG. 7 C in which the non-embedded lead pad structure is changed to an embedded lead pad structure and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 may be changed as appropriate to the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and a non-embedded or embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 may be configured.
- the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 may be changed as appropriate to the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and a non-embedded or embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 may be configured.
- the embedded TSV 157 a or 157 b may be changed to the TSV/lead line openings 155 a and 155 b .
- These TSV/lead line openings 155 a and 155 b may then cause a non-embedded or embedded lead pad structure to be configured.
- the one pad 151 may be then shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be then provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- the twin contact type two-layer TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, but the present embodiment is not limited to the example.
- the TSV 157 may be formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the second substrate 110 B.
- FIGS. 8 A, 8 B, 8 C, 8 D, 8 E, and 8 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the third configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 8 A, 8 B, 8 C, 8 D, 8 E, and 8 F .
- a solid-state imaging device 4 a illustrated in FIG. 8 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 a , the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 b , and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 4 b illustrated in FIG. 8 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 4 a illustrated in FIG. 8 A in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 b is changed.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 8 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 4 a illustrated in FIG. 8 A in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 b is changed.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 4 c illustrated in FIG. 8 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 4 a illustrated in FIG. 8 A in which the shared contact type two-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the solid-state imaging device 4 c illustrated in FIG. 8 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 4 a illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 4 d illustrated in FIG. 8 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 4 c illustrated in FIG. 8 C in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 4 e illustrated in FIG. 8 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 4 c illustrated in FIG. 8 C in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 4 f illustrated in FIG. 8 F corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 4 d illustrated in FIG. 8 D in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 , and the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 may be changed as appropriate to the TSV/lead line openings 155 , and non-embedded or embedded lead pad structures using the TSV/lead line openings 155 may be configured.
- the one pad 151 may be then shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be then provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, but the present embodiment is not limited to the example.
- the TSV 157 may be formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A.
- twin contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other, depending on the direction in which the TSV 157 is formed, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- FIGS. 9 A, 9 B, 9 C, and 9 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fourth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 9 A, 9 B, 9 C, and 9 D .
- a solid-state imaging device 5 a illustrated in FIG. 9 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSVs 157 a and 157 b , and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 5 b illustrated in FIG. 9 B includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSVs 157 a , 157 b , and 157 c , and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the solid-state imaging device 5 b corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 5 a illustrated in FIG. 9 A in which the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 b is additionally provided (the TSVs 157 a and 157 c in FIG. 9 B respectively correspond to the TSVs 157 a and 157 b in FIG. 9 A ).
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is then formed to reach the upper end of the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 c provided in the second substrate 110 B while penetrating a predetermined wiring line (in the illustrated example, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer) in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A.
- the TSV 157 b is formed to electrically couple a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and the TSV 157 c to each other. Further, the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and the predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 c.
- a solid-state imaging device 5 c illustrated in FIG. 9 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 5 a illustrated in FIG. 9 A in which the shared contact type two-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- a solid-state imaging device 5 d illustrated in FIG. 9 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 5 c illustrated in FIG. 9 C in which the non-embedded lead pad structure is changed to an embedded lead pad structure and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 may be changed as appropriate to the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and a non-embedded or embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 may be configured.
- the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 may be changed as appropriate to the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and a non-embedded or embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 may be configured.
- the embedded TSV 157 a or 157 b may be changed to the TSV/lead line openings 155 a and 155 b .
- These TSV/lead line openings 155 a and 155 b may then cause a non-embedded or embedded lead pad structure to be configured.
- the one pad 151 may be then shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be then provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, but the present embodiment is not limited to the example.
- the TSV 157 may be formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the second substrate 110 B.
- FIGS. 10 A, 10 B, 10 C, 10 D, 10 E, and 10 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fifth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 10 A, 10 B, 10 C, 10 D, 10 E, and 10 F .
- a solid-state imaging device 6 a illustrated in FIG. 10 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 a , the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 b , and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 6 b illustrated in FIG. 10 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 6 a illustrated in FIG. 10 A in which the structure of the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 b is changed.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 6 c illustrated in FIG. 10 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 6 a illustrated in FIG. 10 A in which the shared contact type two-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- a solid-state imaging device 6 d illustrated in FIG. 10 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 6 c illustrated in FIG. 10 C in which the structure of the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 6 e illustrated in FIG. 10 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 6 c illustrated in FIG. 10 C in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure.
- a solid-state imaging device 6 f illustrated in FIG. 10 F corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 6 d illustrated in FIG. 10 D in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the shared contact type two-layer and three-layer TSVs 157 may be changed as appropriate to the TSV/lead line openings 155 , and non-embedded or embedded lead pad structures using the TSV/lead line openings 155 may be configured.
- the one pad 151 may be then shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be then provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- FIGS. 11 A, 11 B, 11 C, 11 D, and 11 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the sixth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 11 A, 11 B, 11 C, 11 D, and 11 E .
- a solid-state imaging device 7 a illustrated in FIG. 11 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 may be formed by performing heat treatment in the state in which the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C are bonded together to bring the electrodes provided to the bonding surface of the second substrate 110 B and the electrodes provided to the bonding surface of the third substrate 110 C into contact with each other, and joining the electrodes to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 includes an electrode formed on the bonding surface in the second substrate 110 B, a via for electrically coupling the electrode to a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 , an electrode formed on the bonding surface in the third substrate 110 C, and a via for electrically coupling the electrode to a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 .
- the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C are then bonded together F-to-B, and a via provided to the second substrate 110 B side is thus formed as a via (i.e., TSV) that penetrates the semiconductor substrate 121 .
- a solid-state imaging device 7 b illustrated in FIG. 11 B includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSVs 157 a and 157 b , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the solid-state imaging device 7 b corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 7 a illustrated in FIG. 11 A in which the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 b is additionally provided (the TSV 157 a in FIG. 11 B corresponds to the TSV 157 in FIG. 11 A ).
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is then formed to reach a wiring line included in the electrode junction structure 159 provided in the second substrate 110 B while penetrating a predetermined wiring line (in the illustrated example, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer) in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A.
- the TSV 157 b is formed to electrically couple a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and the electrode junction structure 159 to each other. Further, the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and the predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C are electrically coupled to each other by the electrode junction structure 159 .
- a solid-state imaging device 7 c illustrated in FIG. 11 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 7 a illustrated in FIG. 11 A in which the shared contact type two-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the TSV 157 , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- a solid-state imaging device 7 d illustrated in FIG. 11 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 7 b illustrated in FIG. 11 B in which the shared contact type two-layer TSV/lead line openings 155 a and 155 b are provided instead of the TSVs 157 a and 157 b , and the embedded pad structures are changed to non-embedded lead pad structures using the TSV/lead line openings 155 a and 155 b (i.e., the TSV/lead line openings 155 a and 155 b , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the respective pads 151 are provided to the two TSV/lead line openings 155 a and 155 b.
- a solid-state imaging device 7 e illustrated in FIG. 11 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 7 c illustrated in FIG. 11 C in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the respective pads 151 are provided to the two TSV/lead line openings 155 a and 155 b , but the one pad 151 may be shared by these two TSV/lead line openings 155 a and 155 b , for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E .
- a non-embedded lead pad structure may be provided instead of an embedded lead pad structure, or an embedded lead pad structure may be provided instead of a non-embedded lead pad structure.
- an embedded lead pad structure may be provided instead of a non-embedded lead pad structure.
- one or both of the two illustrated non-embedded lead pad structures may be changed to embedded lead pad structures.
- FIGS. 12 A, 12 B, 12 C, and 12 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the seventh configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 12 A, 12 B, 12 C, and 12 D .
- a solid-state imaging device 8 a illustrated in FIG. 12 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 a , the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 b , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 8 b illustrated in FIG. 12 B includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSVs 157 a and 157 b , the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 c , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the configuration of the TSV 157 a is similar to the configuration of the TSV 157 a illustrated in FIG. 12 A .
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is then formed to reach a wiring line included in the electrode junction structure 159 provided in the second substrate 110 B while penetrating a predetermined wiring line (in the illustrated example, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer) in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A. That is, the TSV 157 b is formed to electrically couple a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and the electrode junction structure 159 to each other.
- a predetermined wiring line in the illustrated example, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and the predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C are electrically coupled to each other by the electrode junction structure 159 .
- the TSV 157 c is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 c electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 8 c illustrated in FIG. 12 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 8 a illustrated in FIG. 12 A in which the shared contact type two-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the solid-state imaging device 8 c illustrated in FIG. 12 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 8 a illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 8 d illustrated in FIG. 12 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 8 c illustrated in FIG. 12 C in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 may be changed as appropriate to the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and a non-embedded or embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 may be configured.
- the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 may be changed as appropriate to the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and a non-embedded or embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 may be configured.
- the embedded TSV 157 a or 157 b may be changed to the TSV/lead line openings 155 a and 155 b .
- These TSV/lead line openings 155 a and 155 b may then cause a non-embedded or embedded lead pad structure to be configured.
- the one pad 151 may be then shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be then provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- FIGS. 13 A, 13 B, 13 C, 13 E, 13 D, and 13 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 13 A, 13 B, 13 C, 13 E, 13 D, and 13 F .
- a solid-state imaging device 9 a illustrated in FIG. 13 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 a , the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 b , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 9 b illustrated in FIG. 13 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 9 a illustrated in FIG. 13 A in which the configuration of the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C is changed.
- the multi-layered wiring layer 135 includes both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer, but in the configuration illustrated in FIG. 13 B , the multi-layered wiring layer 135 includes only the first metal wiring layer.
- a solid-state imaging device 9 c illustrated in FIG. 13 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 9 a illustrated in FIG. 13 A in which the shared contact type two-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- a solid-state imaging device 9 d illustrated in FIG. 13 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 9 c illustrated in FIG. 13 C in which the configuration of the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C is changed.
- the multi-layered wiring layer 135 includes both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer, but in the configuration illustrated in FIG. 13 D , the multi-layered wiring layer 135 includes only the first metal wiring layer.
- a solid-state imaging device 9 e illustrated in FIG. 13 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 9 d illustrated in FIG. 13 D in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure.
- a solid-state imaging device 9 f illustrated in FIG. 13 F corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 9 e illustrated in FIG. 13 E in which the configuration of the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C is changed.
- the multi-layered wiring layer 135 includes only the first metal wiring layer, but in the configuration illustrated in FIG. 13 F , the multi-layered wiring layer 135 includes both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A, but the present embodiment is not limited to the example.
- the TSV 157 may be formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C.
- twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 may be changed as appropriate to the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and a non-embedded or embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 may be configured.
- the one pad 151 may be then shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be then provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- twin contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other, depending on the direction in which the TSV 157 is formed, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- FIGS. 14 A, 14 B, 14 C, 14 E, and 14 D is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the ninth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 14 A, 14 B, 14 C, 14 E, and 14 D .
- a solid-state imaging device 10 a illustrated in FIG. 14 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSVs 157 a and 157 b , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 10 b illustrated in FIG. 14 B includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSVs 157 a , 157 b , and 157 c , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the solid-state imaging device 10 b corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 10 a illustrated in FIG. 14 A in which the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 b is additionally provided (the TSVs 157 a and 157 c in FIG. 10 B respectively correspond to the TSVs 157 a and 157 b in FIG. 10 A ).
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is then formed to reach the upper end of the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 c provided in the second substrate 110 B while penetrating a predetermined wiring line (in the illustrated example, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer) in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A.
- the TSV 157 b is formed to electrically couple a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and the TSV 157 c to each other. Further, the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and the predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 c.
- a solid-state imaging device 10 c illustrated in FIG. 14 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 10 a illustrated in FIG. 14 A in which the shared contact type two-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- a solid-state imaging device 10 d illustrated in FIG. 14 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 10 c illustrated in FIG. 14 C in which the non-embedded lead pad structure is changed to an embedded lead pad structure.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 may be changed as appropriate to the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and a non-embedded or embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 may be configured.
- the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 may be changed as appropriate to the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and a non-embedded or embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 may be configured.
- the embedded TSV 157 a or 157 b may be changed to the TSV/lead line openings 155 a and 155 b .
- These TSV/lead line openings 155 a and 155 b may then cause a non-embedded or embedded lead pad structure to be configured.
- the one pad 151 may be then shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be then provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, but the present embodiment is not limited to the example.
- the TSV 157 may be formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the second substrate 110 B.
- FIGS. 15 A, 15 B, 15 C, 15 D, 15 E, and 15 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the tenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 15 A, 15 B, 15 C, 15 D, 15 E, and 15 F .
- a solid-state imaging device 11 a illustrated in FIG. 15 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 a , the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 b , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 11 b illustrated in FIG. 15 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 11 a illustrated in FIG. 15 A in which the configuration of the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C is changed.
- the multi-layered wiring layer 135 includes both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer, but in the configuration illustrated in FIG. 15 B , the multi-layered wiring layer 135 includes only the first metal wiring layer.
- a solid-state imaging device 11 c illustrated in FIG. 15 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 11 a illustrated in FIG. 15 A in which the shared contact type two-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- a solid-state imaging device 11 d illustrated in FIG. 15 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 11 c illustrated in FIG. 15 C in which the configuration of the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C is changed.
- the multi-layered wiring layer 135 includes both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer, but in the configuration illustrated in FIG. 15 D , the multi-layered wiring layer 135 includes only the first metal wiring layer.
- a solid-state imaging device 11 e illustrated in FIG. 15 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 11 d illustrated in FIG. 15 D in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure.
- a solid-state imaging device 11 f illustrated in FIG. 15 F corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 11 e illustrated in FIG. 15 E in which the configuration of the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C is changed.
- the multi-layered wiring layer 135 includes only the first metal wiring layer, but in the configuration illustrated in FIG. 15 F , the multi-layered wiring layer 135 includes both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A, but the present embodiment is not limited to the example.
- the TSV 157 may be formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C.
- the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 may be changed as appropriate to the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and a non-embedded or embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 may be configured.
- the one pad 151 may be then shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be then provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- FIGS. 16 A, 16 B, 16 C, 16 D, 16 E, and 16 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eleventh configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 16 A, 16 B, 16 C, 16 D, 16 E, and 16 F .
- the solid-state imaging device 12 a illustrated in FIG. 16 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 , an embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and the pad opening 153 a that exposes the pad 151 ), and an embedded pad structure for the third substrate 110 C (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C and the pad opening 153 b that exposes the pad 151 ).
- an embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and the pad opening 153 a that exposes the pad 151
- an embedded pad structure for the third substrate 110 C i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C and the pad opening 153 b that exposes the pad 151 .
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 12 b illustrated in FIG. 16 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 12 a illustrated in FIG. 16 A in which a substrate provided with the pad 151 is changed and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the TSV 157 is changed.
- an embedded pad structure for the first substrate 110 A i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and the pad opening 153 a that exposes the pad 151
- the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B is provided instead of the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 12 c illustrated in FIG. 16 C includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and non-embedded three-layer TSV 157 , and a non-embedded lead pad structure for the first substrate 110 A (i.e., the lead line opening 155 for a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A).
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 12 d illustrated in FIG. 16 D includes, as coupling structures, the TSV/lead line opening 155 a (having a configuration similar to that of the shared contact type and non-embedded three-layer TSV 157 ), and a non-embedded lead pad structure for the third substrate 110 C (i.e., the lead line opening 155 b for a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C, and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A).
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 a having a configuration similar to that of the shared contact type and non-embedded three-layer TSV 157
- a non-embedded lead pad structure for the third substrate 110 C i.e., the lead line opening 155 b for a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C, and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 1 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the one pad 151 is shared by the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the lead line opening 155 b.
- a solid-state imaging device 12 e illustrated in FIG. 16 E corresponds to the above-described solid-state imaging device 2 j illustrated in FIG. 6 J in which the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 .
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- an embedded lead pad structure using the electrically-conductive material film 501 and the resin film 503 is provided.
- a solid-state imaging device 12 f illustrated in FIG. 16 F corresponds to the above-described solid-state imaging device 2 k illustrated in FIG. 6 K in which the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 .
- the solid-state imaging device 12 f illustrated in FIG. 16 F corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 2 k illustrated in FIG. 6 K in which the configuration of the lead pad structure is changed.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a non-embedded lead pad structure for the first substrate 110 A i.e., the lead line opening 155 for a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A
- an embedded lead pad structure using the electrically-conductive material film 501 and the resin film 503 is provided.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the one pad 151 may be shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 6 E in the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the one pad 151 is shared by the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the lead line opening 155 , but the plurality of respective pads 151 may be provided in association with these TSV/lead line opening 155 a and lead line opening 155 .
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, but the present embodiment is not limited to the example.
- the TSV 157 may be formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A.
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- FIGS. 17 A, 17 B, 17 C, 17 D, and 17 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the twelfth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 17 A, 17 B, 17 C, 17 D, and 17 E .
- a solid-state imaging device 13 a illustrated in FIG. 17 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a , the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 b , and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 1 In the configuration illustrated in FIG. 1
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 13 b illustrated in FIG. 17 B includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and non-embedded three-layer TSV 157 a , the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 b , and a non-embedded lead pad structure for the first substrate 110 A (i.e., the lead line opening 155 for a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 13 c illustrated in FIG. 17 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 13 b illustrated in FIG. 17 B in which the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type and non-embedded three-layer TSV 157 a and the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 b is changed. Specifically, in the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 13 d illustrated in FIG. 17 D includes, as coupling structures, an embedded lead pad structure (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 and the pad 151 embedded in the insulating film 109 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A) using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (having a configuration similar to that of the shared contact type and non-embedded three-layer TSV 157 ), and the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 .
- an embedded lead pad structure i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 and the pad 151 embedded in the insulating film 109 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 having a configuration similar to that of the shared contact type and non-embedded three-layer TSV 157
- twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 .
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 1 In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 13 e illustrated in FIG. 17 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 13 d illustrated in FIG. 17 D in which the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the TSV/lead line opening 155 and the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 electrically coupled by the TSV/lead line opening 155 and the wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 electrically coupled by the TSV 157 are then the same. That is, the TSV/lead line opening 155 and the TSV 157 are formed to contact the same wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C.
- the type of wiring lines to which the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 and the twin contact type two-layer TSV 157 are coupled is not limited in the respective configurations illustrated in FIGS. 17 A, 17 B, 17 C, 17 D, and 17 E .
- These TSV 157 may be coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer or may be coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer.
- the wiring lines in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 electrically coupled by these TSVs 157 may be changed to wiring lines of the second metal wiring layer.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the one pad 151 may be shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- the twin contact type two-layer TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, but the present embodiment is not limited to the example.
- the TSV 157 may be formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the second substrate 110 B.
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- FIGS. 18 A, 18 B, 18 C, 18 D, 18 E, 18 F, 18 G, 18 H, 18 I, and 18 J is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the thirteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 18 A, 18 B, 18 C, 18 D, 18 E, 18 F, 18 G, 18 H, 18 I, and 18 J .
- a solid-state imaging device 14 a illustrated in FIG. 18 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a , the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 b , and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 14 b illustrated in FIG. 18 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 14 a illustrated in FIG. 18 A in which the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the solid-state imaging device 14 b illustrated in FIG. 18 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 14 a illustrated in FIG. 18 A in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is further changed.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 18 B the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 14 c illustrated in FIG. 18 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 14 b illustrated in FIG. 18 B in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 14 d illustrated in FIG. 18 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 14 b illustrated in FIG. 18 B in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 and the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed. Specifically, in the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 14 e illustrated in FIG. 18 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 14 d illustrated in FIG. 18 D in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 14 f illustrated in FIG. 18 F corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 14 a illustrated in FIG. 18 A in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 b is changed.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 18 F the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 14 g illustrated in FIG. 18 G corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 14 f illustrated in FIG. 18 F in which the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a
- the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 1 In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 14 h illustrated in FIG. 18 H corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 14 g illustrated in FIG. 18 G in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 14 i illustrated in FIG. 18 I corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 14 g illustrated in FIG. 18 G in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is changed. Specifically, in the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 14 j illustrated in FIG. 18 J corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 14 i illustrated in FIG. 18 I in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 , and the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 may be changed as appropriate to the TSV/lead line openings 155 , and non-embedded or embedded lead pad structures using the TSV/lead line openings 155 may be configured.
- the one pad 151 may be then shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be then provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- twin contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other, depending on the direction in which the TSV 157 is formed, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- FIGS. 19 A, 19 B, 19 C, 19 D, and 19 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fourteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 19 A, 19 B, 19 C, 19 D , and 19 E.
- a solid-state imaging device 15 a illustrated in FIG. 19 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a , the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 b , and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 15 b illustrated in FIG. 19 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 15 a illustrated in FIG. 19 A in which the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the solid-state imaging device 15 b illustrated in FIG. 19 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 15 a illustrated in FIG. 19 A in which the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 19 B the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 15 c illustrated in FIG. 19 C corresponds to a configuration in which the solid-state imaging device 15 b illustrated in FIG. 19 B is further provided with a non-embedded lead pad structure for the first substrate 110 A (i.e., the lead line opening 155 b for a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A).
- the pad 151 is provided to each of the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the lead line opening 155 b.
- a solid-state imaging device 15 d illustrated in FIG. 19 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 15 b illustrated in FIG. 19 B in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure.
- a solid-state imaging device 15 e illustrated in FIG. 19 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 15 c illustrated in FIG. 19 C in which embedded lead pad structures are provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structures for the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the lead line opening 155 b.
- the type of wiring lines to which the shared contact type two-layer and three-layer TSVs 157 are coupled is not limited in the respective configurations illustrated in FIGS. 19 A, 19 B, 19 C, 19 D, and 19 E .
- These TSV 157 may be coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer or may be coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer.
- the wiring lines in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 electrically coupled by the shared contact type two-layer and three-layer TSVs 157 a and 157 b may be changed from wiring lines of the first metal wiring layer to wiring lines of the second metal wiring layer.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the pad 151 is provided to each of the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the lead line opening 155 b , but the present embodiment is not limited to the example.
- the one pad 151 may be shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, but the present embodiment is not limited to the example.
- the TSV 157 may be formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the second substrate 110 B.
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- FIGS. 20 A, 20 B, 20 C, 20 D, 20 E, and 20 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the fifteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 20 A, 20 B, 20 C, 20 D, 20 E, and 20 F .
- a solid-state imaging device 16 a illustrated in FIG. 20 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSVs 157 a and 157 b , and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the solid-state imaging device 16 b illustrated in FIG. 20 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 16 a illustrated in FIG. 20 A in which the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a is changed.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 16 c illustrated in FIG. 20 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 16 b illustrated in FIG. 20 B in which the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a
- the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 1 In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 16 d illustrated in FIG. 20 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 16 c illustrated in FIG. 20 C in which a non-embedded lead pad structure for the first substrate 110 A (i.e., the lead line opening 155 b for a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A) is further provided and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 a is changed. Specifically, in the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the pad 151 is provided to each of the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the lead line opening 155 b.
- a solid-state imaging device 16 e illustrated in FIG. 20 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 16 c illustrated in FIG. 20 C in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure.
- the solid-state imaging device 16 f illustrated in FIG. 20 F corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 16 e illustrated in FIG. 20 E in which the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is changed.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the pad 151 is provided to each of the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the lead line opening 155 b , but the present embodiment is not limited to the example.
- the one pad 151 may be shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- FIGS. 21 A, 21 B, 21 C, 21 D, 21 E, and 21 F is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the sixteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 21 A, 21 B, 21 C, 21 D, 21 E, and 21 F .
- a solid-state imaging device 17 a illustrated in FIG. 21 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 17 b illustrated in FIG. 21 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 17 a illustrated in FIG. 21 A in which the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 17 c illustrated in FIG. 21 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 17 b illustrated in FIG. 21 B in which the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157
- the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 1 In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the solid-state imaging device 17 d illustrated in FIG. 21 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 17 c illustrated in FIG. 21 C in which the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is changed.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 17 e illustrated in FIG. 21 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 17 c illustrated in FIG. 21 C in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure.
- a solid-state imaging device 17 f illustrated in FIG. 21 F corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 17 e illustrated in FIG. 21 E in which the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is changed.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the other lead line opening 155 and/or TSV/lead line opening 155 may be further provided.
- the one pad 151 may be then shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be then provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- FIGS. 22 A, 22 b , 22 C, 22 D, and 22 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the seventeenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 22 A, 22 b , 22 C, 22 D, and 22 E.
- a solid-state imaging device 18 a illustrated in FIG. 22 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a , the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 b , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 18 b illustrated in FIG. 22 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 18 a illustrated in FIG. 22 A in which the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the solid-state imaging device 18 b illustrated in FIG. 22 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 18 a illustrated in FIG. 22 A in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 b is further changed.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 22 B the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 18 c illustrated in FIG. 22 C includes, as coupling structures, the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, a non-embedded lead pad structure (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A) using the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 a , and a non-embedded lead pad structure (i.e., the lead line opening 155 b for a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A) for the first substrate 110 A.
- a non-embedded lead pad structure i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 1 is the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the second substrate 110 B, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 18 d illustrated in FIG. 22 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 18 b illustrated in FIG. 22 B in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 and the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 is changed. Specifically, in the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 18 e illustrated in FIG. 22 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 18 c illustrated in FIG. 22 C in which the electrically-conductive material films of the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the lead line opening 155 b are integrally formed, and the pad 151 provided to each of these films is embedded in the insulating film 109 (i.e., in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure).
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the one or more pads 151 may be shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E or 22 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- twin contact type two-layer TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other may be formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, or may be formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the second substrate 110 B.
- the direction of the TSV 157 may be changed as appropriate. For example, in the configuration illustrated in FIG. 22 A , the direction of the TSV 157 b may be reversed (i.e., the TSV 157 b may be formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C).
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- FIGS. 23 A, 23 B, 23 C, 23 D, 23 E, 23 F, 23 G, 23 H, 23 I, and 23 J is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the eighteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 23 A, 23 B, 23 C, 23 D, 23 E, 23 F, 23 G, 23 H, 23 I, and 23 J .
- a solid-state imaging device 19 a illustrated in FIG. 23 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a , the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 b , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 19 b illustrated in FIG. 23 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 19 a illustrated in FIG. 23 A in which the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the solid-state imaging device 19 b illustrated in FIG. 23 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 19 a illustrated in FIG. 23 A in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 b is further changed.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 23 B the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 19 c illustrated in FIG. 23 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 19 b illustrated in FIG. 23 B in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 19 d illustrated in FIG. 23 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 19 b illustrated in FIG. 23 B in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 and the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed. Specifically, in the configuration illustrated in FIG. 23 D
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 19 e illustrated in FIG. 23 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 19 d illustrated in FIG. 23 D in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 19 f illustrated in FIG. 23 F corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 19 a illustrated in FIG. 23 A in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 b is changed.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 19 g illustrated in FIG. 23 G corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 19 f illustrated in FIG. 23 F in which the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the solid-state imaging device 19 g illustrated in FIG. 23 G corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 19 f illustrated in FIG. 23 F in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 b is further changed.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 23 G the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 19 h illustrated in FIG. 23 H corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 19 g illustrated in FIG. 23 G in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 19 i illustrated in FIG. 23 I corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 19 g illustrated in FIG. 23 G in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is changed. Specifically, in the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 19 j illustrated in FIG. 23 J corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 19 i illustrated in FIG. 23 I in which the structure of the twin contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 is changed.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B to each other.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 , and the twin contact type three-layer TSV 157 may be changed as appropriate to the TSV/lead line openings 155 , and non-embedded or embedded lead pad structures using the TSV/lead line openings 155 may be configured.
- the one pad 151 may be then shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be then provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 F .
- twin contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other, depending on the direction in which the TSV 157 is formed, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed. For example, in the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the twin contact type three-layer TSV 157 may be provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the twin contact type three-layer TSV 157 may be provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- FIGS. 24 A, 24 B, 24 C, 24 D, and 24 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the nineteenth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 24 A, 24 B, 24 C, 24 D , and 24 E.
- a solid-state imaging device 20 a illustrated in FIG. 24 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSV 157 a , the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 b , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 20 b illustrated in FIG. 24 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 20 a illustrated in FIG. 24 A in which the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the solid-state imaging device 20 b illustrated in FIG. 24 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 20 a illustrated in FIG. 24 A in which the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 b is further changed.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 24 B the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the shared contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 20 c illustrated in FIG. 24 C includes, as coupling structures, the twin contact type and embedded two-layer TSV 157 , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, a non-embedded lead pad structure (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A) using the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 a , and a non-embedded lead pad structure (i.e., the lead line opening 155 b for a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A) for the first substrate 110 A.
- a non-embedded lead pad structure i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 1 is the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 20 d illustrated in FIG. 24 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 20 b illustrated in FIG. 24 B in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure.
- a solid-state imaging device 20 e illustrated in FIG. 24 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 20 c illustrated in FIG. 24 C in which the pad 151 provided to each of the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the lead line opening 155 b is embedded in the insulating film 109 (i.e., in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure).
- the type of wiring lines to which the shared contact type two-layer and three-layer TSVs 157 are coupled is not limited in the respective configurations illustrated in FIGS. 24 A, 24 B, 24 C, 24 D, and 24 E .
- These TSV 157 may be coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer or may be coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer.
- the wiring lines in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 to which the shared contact type two-layer and three-layer TSVs 157 a and 157 b are electrically coupled may be changed from the illustrated wiring lines of the first metal wiring layer to wiring lines of the second metal wiring layer.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the one pad 151 may be shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E, or the plurality of pads 151 may be provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIGS. 6 F, 24 C, and 24 E .
- the shared contact type two-layer TSV 157 that electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other is formed from the front surface side of the second substrate 110 B toward the third substrate 110 C, but the present embodiment is not limited to the example.
- the TSV 157 may be formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the second substrate 110 B.
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- FIGS. 25 A, 25 B, 25 C, 25 D, and 25 E is a vertical cross-sectional view of a schematic configuration of the solid-state imaging device according to the twentieth configuration example of the present embodiment.
- the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment may have any of configurations illustrated in FIGS. 25 A, 25 B, 25 C, 25 D , and 25 E.
- a solid-state imaging device 21 a illustrated in FIG. 25 A includes, as coupling structures, the shared contact type and embedded three-layer TSVs 157 a and 157 b , the electrode junction structure 159 provided between the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C, and the embedded pad structure for the second substrate 110 B (i.e., the pad 151 provided in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and the pad opening 153 that exposes the pad 151 ).
- the TSV 157 a is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other. In the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV 157 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b is formed from the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C toward the first substrate 110 A, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV 157 b electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the electrode junction structure 159 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in the second substrate 110 B and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 21 b illustrated in FIG. 25 B corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 21 a illustrated in FIG. 25 A in which the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 is provided instead of the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 a , and the embedded pad structure is changed to a non-embedded lead pad structure using the TSV/lead line opening 155 (i.e., the TSV/lead line opening 155 , and the pad 151 on the back surface of the first substrate 110 A).
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the configuration illustrated in FIG. 25 B the TSV/lead line opening 155 is formed from the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A toward the third substrate 110 C, and is provided to electrically couple the respective signal lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couple the respective power supply lines included in the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, and the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 21 c illustrated in FIG. 25 C corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 21 b illustrated in FIG. 25 B in which a non-embedded lead pad structure for the first substrate 110 A (i.e., the lead line opening 155 b for a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A) is further provided and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the TSV/lead line opening 155 is further changed.
- a non-embedded lead pad structure for the first substrate 110 A i.e., the lead line opening 155 b for a predetermined wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A and the pad 151 on the back surface side of the first substrate 110 A
- the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the TSV/lead line opening 155 is further changed.
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 21 d illustrated in FIG. 25 D corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 21 b illustrated in FIG. 25 B in which an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the TSV/lead line opening 155 is further changed. Specifically, in the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the TSV/lead line opening 155 electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- a solid-state imaging device 21 e illustrated in FIG. 25 E corresponds to the solid-state imaging device 21 c illustrated in FIG. 25 C in which the pad 151 provided to each of the TSV/lead line opening 155 a and the lead line opening 155 b is embedded in the insulating film 109 (i.e., an embedded lead pad structure is provided instead of the non-embedded lead pad structure), and the type of wiring lines electrically coupled by the TSV/lead line opening 155 is further changed. Specifically, in the configuration illustrated in FIG.
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV/lead line opening 155 a electrically couples a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 105 of the first substrate 110 A, a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 125 of the second substrate 110 B, and a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 of the third substrate 110 C to each other.
- the type of wiring line to which the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 is coupled is not limited in the respective configurations illustrated in FIGS. 25 A, 25 B, 25 C, 25 D, and 25 E .
- the TSV 157 may be coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the first metal wiring layer or may be coupled to a predetermined wiring line of the second metal wiring layer.
- the wiring line in the multi-layered wiring layer 135 to which the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 a is electrically coupled may be changed from the illustrated wiring line of the first metal wiring layer to a wiring line of the second metal wiring layer.
- each of the multi-layered wiring layers 105 , 125 , and 135 may include only the first metal wiring layer, may include only the second metal wiring layer, or may include both the first metal wiring layer and the second metal wiring layer.
- the one pad 151 may be shared by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIG. 6 E , or the plurality of pads 151 may be provided in association with the respective wiring lines drawn out by the plurality of these structures, for example, as illustrated in FIGS. 6 F, 25 C, and 25 E .
- the shared contact type three-layer TSV 157 electrically couples the respective signal lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other and electrically couples the respective power supply lines included in at least any two of the first substrate 110 A, the second substrate 110 B, or the third substrate 110 C to each other, and the substrates including the respective signal lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 and the power supply lines that are electrically coupled to each other by the TSV 157 may be optionally changed.
- the TSV 157 in a manner that the upper end thereof is exposed on the back surface side of the third substrate 110 C.
- the upper end of the TSV 157 exposed in this way is allowed to function as an electrode for electrically coupling the solid-state imaging device to the outside.
- a solder bump or the like may be provided on the exposed upper end of the TSV 157 to electrically couple the solid-state imaging device and an external device to each other through the solder bump or the like.
- the embedded pad structure or the lead pad structure may be applied.
- the lead pad structure a non-embedded lead pad structure or an embedded lead pad structure may be applied.
- solid-state imaging devices 1 to 21 e Application examples of the solid-state imaging devices 1 to 21 e according to the present embodiment described above are described. Several examples of an electronic apparatus to which the solid-state imaging devices 1 to 21 e may be applied are described here.
- FIG. 26 A is a diagram illustrating the appearance of a smartphone that is an example of the electronic apparatus to which the solid-state imaging devices 1 to 21 e according to the present embodiment may be applied.
- a smartphone 901 includes an operation unit 903 that includes a button to receive an operation input made by a user, a display unit 905 that displays various kinds of information, and an imaging unit (not illustrated) that is provided in a housing and electronically shoots an image of an object to be observed.
- the imaging unit may include the solid-state imaging devices 1 to 21 e.
- FIGS. 26 B and 26 C are diagram illustrating the appearance of a digital camera that is another example of the electronic apparatus to which the solid-state imaging devices 1 to 21 e according to the present embodiment may be applied.
- FIG. 26 B illustrates the appearance of a digital camera 911 as viewed from the front (subject side)
- FIG. 26 C illustrates the appearance of the digital camera 911 as viewed from the back. As illustrated in FIGS.
- the digital camera 911 includes a main body (camera body) 913 , an interchangeable lens unit 915 , a grip unit 917 that is grasped by a user at the time of shooting, a monitor 919 that displays various kinds of information, an EVF 921 that displays a through image observed by a user at the time of shooting, and an imaging unit (not illustrated) that is provided in a housing and electronically shoots an image of an object to be observed.
- the imaging unit may include the solid-state imaging devices 1 to 21 e.
- the electronic apparatus to which the solid-state imaging devices 1 to 21 e according to the present embodiment may be applied has been described above.
- the electronic apparatus to which the solid-state imaging devices 1 to 21 e may be applied is not limited to those exemplified above, but the solid-state imaging devices 1 to 21 e are applicable as imaging units mounted on any electronic apparatus such as a video camera, a spectacle-type wearable device, an HMD (Head Mounted Display), a tablet PC, or a game console.
- FIG. 27 A is a cross-sectional view of a configuration example of a solid-state imaging device to which the technology according to the present disclosure may be applied.
- a PD (photodiode) 20019 receives incident light 20001 coming from the back surface (upper surface in the diagram) side of a semiconductor substrate 20018 .
- a planarization film 20013 Above the PD 20019 , a planarization film 20013 , a CF (color filter) 20012 , and a microlens 20011 are provided.
- the incident light 20001 sequentially passing through the respective units is received by a light-receiving surface 20017 , and is subjected to photoelectric conversion.
- an n-type semiconductor region 20020 is formed as a charge accumulation region that accumulates charges (electrons).
- the n-type semiconductor region 20020 is provided inside p-type semiconductor regions 20016 and 20041 of the semiconductor substrate 20018 .
- the front surface (lower surface) side of the semiconductor substrate 20018 of the n-type semiconductor region 20020 is provided with the p-type semiconductor region 20041 having higher impurity concentration than that of the back surface (upper surface) side.
- the PD 20019 has an HAD (Hole-Accumulation Diode) structure, and the p-type semiconductor regions 20016 and 20041 are formed to suppress the generation of dark currents at the respective interfaces with the upper surface side and lower surface side of the n-type semiconductor region 20020 .
- HAD Hole-Accumulation Diode
- a pixel separation unit 20030 that electrically separates a plurality of pixels 20010 from each other is provided inside the semiconductor substrate 20018 , and the PD 20019 is provided to a region defined by this pixel separation unit 20030 .
- the pixel separation unit 20030 is formed in the shape of a grid to be interposed between the plurality of pixels 20010 , for example, and the PD 20019 is formed in a region defined by this pixel separation unit 20030 .
- each PD 20019 the anode is grounded.
- signal charges e.g., electrons
- VSL vertical signal line
- a wiring layer 20050 is provided to the front surface (lower surface) of the semiconductor substrate 20018 that is opposed to the back surface (upper surface) provided with the respective units such as a light-shielding film 20014 , the CF 20012 , and the microlens 20011 .
- the wiring layer 20050 includes a wiring line 20051 and an insulating layer 20052 .
- the wiring line 20051 is formed in the insulating layer 20052 , and electrically coupled to each element.
- the wiring layer 20050 is a so-called multi-layered wiring layer, and is formed by alternately stacking interlayer insulating films and the wiring lines 20051 a plurality of times.
- the interlayer insulating films are included in the insulating layer 20052 .
- wiring lines 20051 wiring lines to a Tr such as the transfer Tr for reading out charges from the PD 20019 , and respective wiring lines such as the VSL are stacked with the insulating layer 20052 interposed therebetween.
- the wiring layer 20050 is provided with a support substrate 20061 on the surface opposite to the side on which the PD 20019 is provided.
- a substrate including a silicon semiconductor and having a thickness of several hundreds of ⁇ m is provided as the support substrate 20061 .
- the light-shielding film 20014 is provided to the back surface (upper surface in the diagram) side of the semiconductor substrate 20018 .
- the light-shielding film 20014 is configured to block a portion of the incident light 20001 from above the semiconductor substrate 20018 toward the back surface of the semiconductor substrate 20018 .
- the light-shielding film 20014 is provided above the pixel separation unit 20030 provided inside the semiconductor substrate 20018 .
- the light-shielding film 20014 is provided to protrude in the shape of a projection with the insulating film 20015 such as a silicon oxide film interposed between the light-shielding film 20014 and the back surface (upper surface) of the semiconductor substrate 20018 .
- the light-shielding film 20014 is not provided, but there is an opening above the PD 20019 provided inside the semiconductor substrate 20018 .
- the light-shielding film 20014 has a grid shape in a plan view, and an opening through which the incident light 20001 passes to the light-receiving surface 20017 is formed.
- the light-shielding film 20014 includes a light-shielding material that blocks light.
- a light-shielding material that blocks light.
- titanium (Ti) films and tungsten (W) films are sequentially stacked to form the light-shielding film 20014 .
- the light-shielding film 20014 is covered with the planarization film 20013 .
- the planarization film 20013 is formed using an insulating material that transmits light.
- the pixel separation unit 20030 includes a groove 20031 , a fixed-charge film 20032 , and an insulating film 20033 .
- the fixed-charge film 20032 is formed on the back surface (upper surface) side of the semiconductor substrate 20018 to cover the groove 20031 that defines the space between the plurality of pixels 20010 .
- the fixed-charge film 20032 is provided to cover the inner surface of the groove 20031 formed on the back surface (upper surface) side of the semiconductor substrate 20018 with a predetermined thickness.
- the insulating film 20033 is then provided to be embedded in (loaded into) the inside of the groove 20031 covered with the fixed-charge film 20032 .
- the fixed-charge film 20032 is formed using a high dielectric material having a negative fixed charge to form a positive-charge (hole) accumulation region at the interface with the semiconductor substrate 20018 and suppress the generation of dark currents.
- the fixed-charge film 20032 is formed to have a negative fixed charge. This causes the negative fixed charge to apply an electric field to the interface with the semiconductor substrate 20018 , and forms a positive-charge (hole) accumulation region.
- the fixed-charge film 20032 by using, for example, a hafnium oxide film (HfO 2 film).
- HfO 2 film a hafnium oxide film
- FIG. 27 B illustrates a schematic configuration of a solid-state imaging device to which the technology according to the present disclosure may be applied.
- a solid-state imaging device 30001 includes an imaging unit (so-called pixel unit) 30003 in which a plurality of pixels 30002 is regularly arranged two-dimensionally, and peripheral circuits, that is, a vertical driving unit 30004 , a horizontal transfer unit 30005 , and an output unit 30006 disposed around the imaging unit 30003 .
- the pixels 30002 each include a photodiode 30021 that is one photoelectric conversion element, and a plurality of pixel transistors (MOS transistors) Tr 1 , Tr 2 , Tr 3 , and Tr 4 .
- the photodiode 30021 has a region in which signal charges photoelectrically converted by using incoming light and generated by the photoelectric conversion are accumulated.
- the plurality of pixel transistors includes the four MOS transistors of a transfer transistor Tr 1 , a reset transistor Tr 2 , an amplifying transistor Tr 3 , and a selection transistor Tr 4 .
- the transfer transistor Tr 1 is a transistor that reads out the signal charges accumulated in the photodiode 30021 into a floating diffusion (FD) region 30022 described below.
- the reset transistor Tr 2 is a transistor for setting a prescribed value as the electric potential of the FD region 30022 .
- the amplifying transistor Tr 3 is a transistor for electrically amplifying the signal charges read out to the FD region 30022 .
- the selection transistor Tr 4 is a transistor for selecting one row of pixels and reading out a pixel signal to the vertical signal line 30008 .
- the source of the transfer transistor Tr 1 is coupled to the photodiode 30021 , and the drain thereof is coupled to the source of the reset transistor Tr 2 .
- the FD region 30022 (corresponding to the drain region of the transfer transistor and the source region of the reset transistor) serving as a charge-to-voltage conversion means between the transfer transistor Tr 1 and the reset transistor Tr 2 is coupled to the gate of the amplifying transistor Tr 3 .
- the source of the amplifying transistor Tr 3 is coupled to the drain of the selection transistor Tr 4 .
- the drain of the reset transistor Tr 2 and the drain of the amplifying transistor Tr 3 are coupled to a power supply voltage supplying unit.
- the source of the selection transistor Tr 4 is coupled to the vertical signal line 30008 .
- Row reset signals ⁇ RST commonly applied to the gates of the reset transistors Tr 2 of the pixels arranged in one row, row transfer signals ⁇ TRG commonly applied in the same manner to the gates of the transfer transistors Tr 1 of the pixels in one row, and row select signals ⁇ SEL commonly applied in the same manner to the gates of the selection transistors Tr 4 in one row are each supplied from the vertical driving unit 30004 .
- the horizontal transfer unit 30005 includes an amplifier or analog/digital converter (ADC) coupled to the vertical signal line 30008 of each column, which is, in this example, an analog/digital converter 30009 , a column selection circuit (switch means) 30007 , and a horizontal transfer line (e.g., bus wiring including the same number of wiring lines as the number of data bit lines) 30010 .
- the output unit 30006 includes an amplifier or an analog/digital converter and/or a signal processing circuit, which is, in this example, a signal processing circuit 30011 that processes an output from the horizontal transfer line 30010 , and an output buffer 30012 .
- the signals of the pixels 30002 in each row are subjected to analog/digital conversion by each analog/digital converter 30009 , read out through the sequentially selected column selection circuit 30007 into horizontal transfer lines 30010 , and horizontally transferred sequentially.
- the image data read out to the horizontal transfer line 30010 is outputted by the output buffer 30012 through the signal processing circuit 30011 .
- the gate of the transfer transistor Tr 1 and the gate of the reset transistor Tr 2 are first turned on to empty all the charges in the photodiode 30021 .
- the gate of the transfer transistor Tr 1 and the gate of the reset transistor Tr 2 are then turned off to accumulate charges.
- the gate of the reset transistor Tr 2 is turned on immediately before the charges of the photodiode 30021 are read out, and the electric potential of the FD region 30022 is reset.
- the gate of the reset transistor Tr 2 is turned off, and the gate of the transfer transistor Tr 1 is turned on to transfer the charges from the photodiodes 30021 to the FD region 30022 .
- the amplifying transistor Tr 3 electrically amplifies signal charges in response to the application of the charges to the gate. Meanwhile, only the selection transistor Tr 4 in a pixel to be read is turned on at the time of FD resetting immediately before the reading, and an image signal, subjected to charge-to-voltage conversion, from the amplifying transistor Tr 3 in the pixel is read out to the vertical signal line 30008 .
- FIG. 27 C is an explanatory diagram illustrating a configuration example of a video camera to which the technology according to the present disclosure may be applied.
- a camera 10000 in this example includes a solid-state imaging device 10001 , an optical system 10002 that guides incident light to a light-receiving sensor unit of the solid-state imaging device 10001 , a shutter device 10003 provided between the solid-state imaging device 10001 and the optical system 10002 , and a drive circuit 10004 that drives the solid-state imaging device 10001 . Further, the camera 10000 includes a signal processing circuit 10005 that processes an output signal of the solid-state imaging device 10001 .
- the optical system (optical lenses) 10002 forms an image of image light (incident light) from a subject on an imaging surface (not illustrated) of the solid-state imaging device 10001 . This causes signal charges to be accumulated in the solid-state imaging device 10001 for a predetermined period.
- the optical system 10002 may include an optical lens group including a plurality of optical lenses.
- the shutter device 10003 controls a light irradiating period and a light shielding period of incident light on the solid-state imaging device 10001 .
- the drive circuit 10004 supplies drive signals to the solid-state imaging device 10001 and the shutter device 10003 .
- the drive circuit 10004 then controls the operation of the solid-state imaging device 10001 , and output signals to the signal processing circuit 10005 and the shutter operation of the shutter device 10003 on the basis of the supplied drive signals. That is, in this example, the operation of transferring signals from the solid-state imaging device 10001 to the signal processing circuit 10005 is performed on the basis of drive signals (timing signals) supplied from the drive circuit 10004 .
- the signal processing circuit 10005 performs various kinds of signal processing on the signals transferred from the solid-state imaging device 10001 .
- the signals (AV-SIGNAL) subjected to the various kinds of signal processing are stored in a storage medium (not illustrated) such as a memory, or outputted to a monitor (not illustrated).
- the technology according to the present disclosure may be applied to an endoscopic surgery system.
- FIG. 27 D is a view depicting an example of a schematic configuration of an endoscopic surgery system to which the technology according to an embodiment of the present disclosure (present technology) can be applied.
- FIG. 27 D a state is illustrated in which a surgeon (medical doctor) 11131 is using an endoscopic surgery system 11000 to perform surgery for a patient 11132 on a patient bed 11133 .
- the endoscopic surgery system 11000 includes an endoscope 11100 , other surgical tools 11110 such as a pneumoperitoneum tube 11111 and an energy device 11112 , a supporting arm apparatus 11120 which supports the endoscope 11100 thereon, and a cart 11200 on which various apparatus for endoscopic surgery are mounted.
- the endoscope 11100 includes a lens barrel 11101 having a region of a predetermined length from a distal end thereof to be inserted into a body cavity of the patient 11132 , and a camera head 11102 connected to a proximal end of the lens barrel 11101 .
- the endoscope 11100 is depicted which includes as a rigid endoscope having the lens barrel 11101 of the hard type.
- the endoscope 11100 may otherwise be included as a flexible endoscope having the lens barrel 11101 of the flexible type.
- the lens barrel 11101 has, at a distal end thereof, an opening in which an objective lens is fitted.
- a light source apparatus 11203 is connected to the endoscope 11100 such that light generated by the light source apparatus 11203 is introduced to a distal end of the lens barrel 11101 by a light guide extending in the inside of the lens barrel 11101 and is irradiated toward an observation target in a body cavity of the patient 11132 through the objective lens.
- the endoscope 11100 may be a forward-viewing endoscope or may be an oblique-viewing endoscope or a side-viewing endoscope.
- An optical system and an image pickup element are provided in the inside of the camera head 11102 such that reflected light (observation light) from the observation target is condensed on the image pickup element by the optical system.
- the observation light is photo-electrically converted by the image pickup element to generate an electric signal corresponding to the observation light, namely, an image signal corresponding to an observation image.
- the image signal is transmitted as RAW data to a CCU 11201 .
- the CCU 11201 includes a central processing unit (CPU), a graphics processing unit (GPU) or the like and integrally controls operation of the endoscope 11100 and a display apparatus 11202 . Further, the CCU 11201 receives an image signal from the camera head 11102 and performs, for the image signal, various image processes for displaying an image based on the image signal such as, for example, a development process (demosaic process).
- a development process demosaic process
- the display apparatus 11202 displays thereon an image based on an image signal, for which the image processes have been performed by the CCU 11201 , under the control of the CCU 11201 .
- the light source apparatus 11203 includes a light source such as, for example, a light emitting diode (LED) and supplies irradiation light upon imaging of a surgical region to the endoscope 11100 .
- a light source such as, for example, a light emitting diode (LED) and supplies irradiation light upon imaging of a surgical region to the endoscope 11100 .
- LED light emitting diode
- An inputting apparatus 11204 is an input interface for the endoscopic surgery system 11000 .
- a user can perform inputting of various kinds of information or instruction inputting to the endoscopic surgery system 11000 through the inputting apparatus 11204 .
- the user would input an instruction or a like to change an image pickup condition (type of irradiation light, magnification, focal distance or the like) by the endoscope 11100 .
- a treatment tool controlling apparatus 11205 controls driving of the energy device 11112 for cautery or incision of a tissue, sealing of a blood vessel or the like.
- a pneumoperitoneum apparatus 11206 feeds gas into a body cavity of the patient 11132 through the pneumoperitoneum tube 11111 to inflate the body cavity in order to secure the field of view of the endoscope 11100 and secure the working space for the surgeon.
- a recorder 11207 is an apparatus capable of recording various kinds of information relating to surgery.
- a printer 11208 is an apparatus capable of printing various kinds of information relating to surgery in various forms such as a text, an image or a graph.
- the light source apparatus 11203 which supplies irradiation light when a surgical region is to be imaged to the endoscope 11100 may include a white light source which includes, for example, an LED, a laser light source or a combination of them.
- a white light source includes a combination of red, green, and blue (RGB) laser light sources, since the output intensity and the output timing can be controlled with a high degree of accuracy for each color (each wavelength), adjustment of the white balance of a picked up image can be performed by the light source apparatus 11203 .
- RGB red, green, and blue
- the light source apparatus 11203 may be controlled such that the intensity of light to be outputted is changed for each predetermined time.
- driving of the image pickup element of the camera head 11102 in synchronism with the timing of the change of the intensity of light to acquire images time-divisionally and synthesizing the images an image of a high dynamic range free from underexposed blocked up shadows and overexposed highlights can be created.
- the light source apparatus 11203 may be configured to supply light of a predetermined wavelength band ready for special light observation.
- special light observation for example, by utilizing the wavelength dependency of absorption of light in a body tissue to irradiate light of a narrow band in comparison with irradiation light upon ordinary observation (namely, white light), narrow band observation (narrow band imaging) of imaging a predetermined tissue such as a blood vessel of a superficial portion of the mucous membrane or the like in a high contrast is performed.
- fluorescent observation for obtaining an image from fluorescent light generated by irradiation of excitation light may be performed.
- fluorescent observation it is possible to perform observation of fluorescent light from a body tissue by irradiating excitation light on the body tissue (autofluorescence observation) or to obtain a fluorescent light image by locally injecting a reagent such as indocyanine green (ICG) into a body tissue and irradiating excitation light corresponding to a fluorescent light wavelength of the reagent upon the body tissue.
- a reagent such as indocyanine green (ICG)
- ICG indocyanine green
- the light source apparatus 11203 can be configured to supply such narrow-band light and/or excitation light suitable for special light observation as described above.
- FIG. 27 E is a block diagram depicting an example of a functional configuration of the camera head 11102 and the CCU 11201 depicted in FIG. 27 D .
- the camera head 11102 includes a lens unit 11401 , an image pickup unit 11402 , a driving unit 11403 , a communication unit 11404 and a camera head controlling unit 11405 .
- the CCU 11201 includes a communication unit 11411 , an image processing unit 11412 and a control unit 11413 .
- the camera head 11102 and the CCU 11201 are connected for communication to each other by a transmission cable 11400 .
- the lens unit 11401 is an optical system, provided at a connecting location to the lens barrel 11101 . Observation light taken in from a distal end of the lens barrel 11101 is guided to the camera head 11102 and introduced into the lens unit 11401 .
- the lens unit 11401 includes a combination of a plurality of lenses including a zoom lens and a focusing lens.
- the number of image pickup elements which is included by the image pickup unit 11402 may be one (single-plate type) or a plural number (multi-plate type). Where the image pickup unit 11402 is configured as that of the multi-plate type, for example, image signals corresponding to respective R, G and B are generated by the image pickup elements, and the image signals may be synthesized to obtain a color image.
- the image pickup unit 11402 may also be configured so as to have a pair of image pickup elements for acquiring respective image signals for the right eye and the left eye ready for three dimensional (3D) display. If 3D display is performed, then the depth of a living body tissue in a surgical region can be comprehended more accurately by the surgeon 11131 . It is to be noted that, where the image pickup unit 11402 is configured as that of stereoscopic type, a plurality of systems of lens units 11401 are provided corresponding to the individual image pickup elements.
- the image pickup unit 11402 may not necessarily be provided on the camera head 11102 .
- the image pickup unit 11402 may be provided immediately behind the objective lens in the inside of the lens barrel 11101 .
- the driving unit 11403 includes an actuator and moves the zoom lens and the focusing lens of the lens unit 11401 by a predetermined distance along an optical axis under the control of the camera head controlling unit 11405 . Consequently, the magnification and the focal point of a picked up image by the image pickup unit 11402 can be adjusted suitably.
- the communication unit 11404 includes a communication apparatus for transmitting and receiving various kinds of information to and from the CCU 11201 .
- the communication unit 11404 transmits an image signal acquired from the image pickup unit 11402 as RAW data to the CCU 11201 through the transmission cable 11400 .
- the communication unit 11404 receives a control signal for controlling driving of the camera head 11102 from the CCU 11201 and supplies the control signal to the camera head controlling unit 11405 .
- the control signal includes information relating to image pickup conditions such as, for example, information that a frame rate of a picked up image is designated, information that an exposure value upon image picking up is designated and/or information that a magnification and a focal point of a picked up image are designated.
- the image pickup conditions such as the frame rate, exposure value, magnification or focal point may be designated by the user or may be set automatically by the control unit 11413 of the CCU 11201 on the basis of an acquired image signal.
- an auto exposure (AE) function, an auto focus (AF) function and an auto white balance (AWB) function are incorporated in the endoscope 11100 .
- the camera head controlling unit 11405 controls driving of the camera head 11102 on the basis of a control signal from the CCU 11201 received through the communication unit 11404 .
- the communication unit 11411 includes a communication apparatus for transmitting and receiving various kinds of information to and from the camera head 11102 .
- the communication unit 11411 receives an image signal transmitted thereto from the camera head 11102 through the transmission cable 11400 .
- the communication unit 11411 transmits a control signal for controlling driving of the camera head 11102 to the camera head 11102 .
- the image signal and the control signal can be transmitted by electrical communication, optical communication or the like.
- the image processing unit 11412 performs various image processes for an image signal in the form of RAW data transmitted thereto from the camera head 11102 .
- the control unit 11413 performs various kinds of control relating to image picking up of a surgical region or the like by the endoscope 11100 and display of a picked up image obtained by image picking up of the surgical region or the like. For example, the control unit 11413 creates a control signal for controlling driving of the camera head 11102 .
- control unit 11413 controls, on the basis of an image signal for which image processes have been performed by the image processing unit 11412 , the display apparatus 11202 to display a picked up image in which the surgical region or the like is imaged.
- control unit 11413 may recognize various objects in the picked up image using various image recognition technologies.
- the control unit 11413 can recognize a surgical tool such as forceps, a particular living body region, bleeding, mist when the energy device 11112 is used and so forth by detecting the shape, color and so forth of edges of objects included in a picked up image.
- the control unit 11413 may cause, when it controls the display apparatus 11202 to display a picked up image, various kinds of surgery supporting information to be displayed in an overlapping manner with an image of the surgical region using a result of the recognition. Where surgery supporting information is displayed in an overlapping manner and presented to the surgeon 11131 , the burden on the surgeon 11131 can be reduced and the surgeon 11131 can proceed with the surgery with certainty.
- the transmission cable 11400 which connects the camera head 11102 and the CCU 11201 to each other is an electric signal cable ready for communication of an electric signal, an optical fiber ready for optical communication or a composite cable ready for both of electrical and optical communications.
- communication is performed by wired communication using the transmission cable 11400
- the communication between the camera head 11102 and the CCU 11201 may be performed by wireless communication.
- the technology according to the present disclosure may be applied to, for example, the image pickup unit 11402 of the camera head 11102 out of the components described above. Applying the technology according to the present disclosure to the image pickup unit 11402 makes it possible to obtain a clearer image of a surgical region. This allows a surgeon to check the surgical region with certainty.
- endoscopic surgery system has been described here as an example, but the technology according to the present disclosure may be additionally applied to, for example, a microscopic surgery system or the like.
- the technology according to the present disclosure may be implemented as a device mounted on any type of mobile body such as an automobile, an electric vehicle, a hybrid electric vehicle, a motorcycle, a bicycle, a personal mobility, an airplane, a drone, a vessel, or a robot.
- FIG. 27 F is a block diagram depicting an example of schematic configuration of a vehicle control system as an example of a mobile body control system to which the technology according to an embodiment of the present disclosure can be applied.
- the vehicle control system 12000 includes a plurality of electronic control units connected to each other via a communication network 12001 .
- the vehicle control system 12000 includes a driving system control unit 12010 , a body system control unit 12020 , an outside-vehicle information detecting unit 12030 , an in-vehicle information detecting unit 12040 , and an integrated control unit 12050 .
- a microcomputer 12051 , a sound/image output section 12052 , and a vehicle-mounted network interface (I/F) 12053 are illustrated as a functional configuration of the integrated control unit 12050 .
- the driving system control unit 12010 controls the operation of devices related to the driving system of the vehicle in accordance with various kinds of programs.
- the driving system control unit 12010 functions as a control device for a driving force generating device for generating the driving force of the vehicle, such as an internal combustion engine, a driving motor, or the like, a driving force transmitting mechanism for transmitting the driving force to wheels, a steering mechanism for adjusting the steering angle of the vehicle, a braking device for generating the braking force of the vehicle, and the like.
- the body system control unit 12020 controls the operation of various kinds of devices provided to a vehicle body in accordance with various kinds of programs.
- the body system control unit 12020 functions as a control device for a keyless entry system, a smart key system, a power window device, or various kinds of lamps such as a headlamp, a backup lamp, a brake lamp, a turn signal, a fog lamp, or the like.
- radio waves transmitted from a mobile device as an alternative to a key or signals of various kinds of switches can be input to the body system control unit 12020 .
- the body system control unit 12020 receives these input radio waves or signals, and controls a door lock device, the power window device, the lamps, or the like of the vehicle.
- the outside-vehicle information detecting unit 12030 detects information about the outside of the vehicle including the vehicle control system 12000 .
- the outside-vehicle information detecting unit 12030 is connected with an imaging section 12031 .
- the outside-vehicle information detecting unit 12030 makes the imaging section 12031 image an image of the outside of the vehicle, and receives the imaged image.
- the outside-vehicle information detecting unit 12030 may perform processing of detecting an object such as a human, a vehicle, an obstacle, a sign, a character on a road surface, or the like, or processing of detecting a distance thereto.
- the imaging section 12031 is an optical sensor that receives light, and which outputs an electric signal corresponding to a received light amount of the light.
- the imaging section 12031 can output the electric signal as an image, or can output the electric signal as information about a measured distance.
- the light received by the imaging section 12031 may be visible light, or may be invisible light such as infrared rays or the like.
- the in-vehicle information detecting unit 12040 detects information about the inside of the vehicle.
- the in-vehicle information detecting unit 12040 is, for example, connected with a driver state detecting section 12041 that detects the state of a driver.
- the driver state detecting section 12041 for example, includes a camera that images the driver.
- the in-vehicle information detecting unit 12040 may calculate a degree of fatigue of the driver or a degree of concentration of the driver, or may determine whether the driver is dozing.
- the microcomputer 12051 can calculate a control target value for the driving force generating device, the steering mechanism, or the braking device on the basis of the information about the inside or outside of the vehicle which information is obtained by the outside-vehicle information detecting unit 12030 or the in-vehicle information detecting unit 12040 , and output a control command to the driving system control unit 12010 .
- the microcomputer 12051 can perform cooperative control intended to implement functions of an advanced driver assistance system (ADAS) which functions include collision avoidance or shock mitigation for the vehicle, following driving based on a following distance, vehicle speed maintaining driving, a warning of collision of the vehicle, a warning of deviation of the vehicle from a lane, or the like.
- ADAS advanced driver assistance system
- the microcomputer 12051 can perform cooperative control intended for automatic driving, which makes the vehicle to travel autonomously without depending on the operation of the driver, or the like, by controlling the driving force generating device, the steering mechanism, the braking device, or the like on the basis of the information about the outside or inside of the vehicle which information is obtained by the outside-vehicle information detecting unit 12030 or the in-vehicle information detecting unit 12040 .
- the microcomputer 12051 can output a control command to the body system control unit 12020 on the basis of the information about the outside of the vehicle which information is obtained by the outside-vehicle information detecting unit 12030 .
- the microcomputer 12051 can perform cooperative control intended to prevent a glare by controlling the headlamp so as to change from a high beam to a low beam, for example, in accordance with the position of a preceding vehicle or an oncoming vehicle detected by the outside-vehicle information detecting unit 12030 .
- the sound/image output section 12052 transmits an output signal of at least one of a sound and an image to an output device capable of visually or auditorily notifying information to an occupant of the vehicle or the outside of the vehicle.
- an audio speaker 12061 a display section 12062 , and an instrument panel 12063 are illustrated as the output device.
- the display section 12062 may, for example, include at least one of an on-board display and a head-up display.
- FIG. 27 G is a diagram depicting an example of the installation position of the imaging section 12031 .
- the imaging section 12031 includes imaging sections 12101 , 12102 , 12103 , 12104 , and 12105 .
- the imaging sections 12101 , 12102 , 12103 , 12104 , and 12105 are, for example, disposed at positions on a front nose, sideview mirrors, a rear bumper, and a back door of the vehicle 12100 as well as a position on an upper portion of a windshield within the interior of the vehicle.
- the imaging section 12101 provided to the front nose and the imaging section 12105 provided to the upper portion of the windshield within the interior of the vehicle obtain mainly an image of the front of the vehicle 12100 .
- the imaging sections 12102 and 12103 provided to the sideview mirrors obtain mainly an image of the sides of the vehicle 12100 .
- the imaging section 12104 provided to the rear bumper or the back door obtains mainly an image of the rear of the vehicle 12100 .
- the imaging section 12105 provided to the upper portion of the windshield within the interior of the vehicle is used mainly to detect a preceding vehicle, a pedestrian, an obstacle, a signal, a traffic sign, a lane, or the like.
- FIG. 27 G depicts an example of photographing ranges of the imaging sections 12101 to 12104 .
- An imaging range 12111 represents the imaging range of the imaging section 12101 provided to the front nose.
- Imaging ranges 12112 and 12113 respectively represent the imaging ranges of the imaging sections 12102 and 12103 provided to the sideview mirrors.
- An imaging range 12114 represents the imaging range of the imaging section 12104 provided to the rear bumper or the back door.
- a bird's-eye image of the vehicle 12100 as viewed from above is obtained by superimposing image data imaged by the imaging sections 12101 to 12104 , for example.
- At least one of the imaging sections 12101 to 12104 may have a function of obtaining distance information.
- at least one of the imaging sections 12101 to 12104 may be a stereo camera constituted of a plurality of imaging elements, or may be an imaging element having pixels for phase difference detection.
- the microcomputer 12051 can determine a distance to each three-dimensional object within the imaging ranges 12111 to 12114 and a temporal change in the distance (relative speed with respect to the vehicle 12100 ) on the basis of the distance information obtained from the imaging sections 12101 to 12104 , and thereby extract, as a preceding vehicle, a nearest three-dimensional object in particular that is present on a traveling path of the vehicle 12100 and which travels in substantially the same direction as the vehicle 12100 at a predetermined speed (for example, equal to or more than 0 km/hour). Further, the microcomputer 12051 can set a following distance to be maintained in front of a preceding vehicle in advance, and perform automatic brake control (including following stop control), automatic acceleration control (including following start control), or the like. It is thus possible to perform cooperative control intended for automatic driving that makes the vehicle travel autonomously without depending on the operation of the driver or the like.
- automatic brake control including following stop control
- automatic acceleration control including following start control
- the microcomputer 12051 can classify three-dimensional object data on three-dimensional objects into three-dimensional object data of a two-wheeled vehicle, a standard-sized vehicle, a large-sized vehicle, a pedestrian, a utility pole, and other three-dimensional objects on the basis of the distance information obtained from the imaging sections 12101 to 12104 , extract the classified three-dimensional object data, and use the extracted three-dimensional object data for automatic avoidance of an obstacle.
- the microcomputer 12051 identifies obstacles around the vehicle 12100 as obstacles that the driver of the vehicle 12100 can recognize visually and obstacles that are difficult for the driver of the vehicle 12100 to recognize visually. Then, the microcomputer 12051 determines a collision risk indicating a risk of collision with each obstacle.
- the microcomputer 12051 In a situation in which the collision risk is equal to or higher than a set value and there is thus a possibility of collision, the microcomputer 12051 outputs a warning to the driver via the audio speaker 12061 or the display section 12062 , and performs forced deceleration or avoidance steering via the driving system control unit 12010 .
- the microcomputer 12051 can thereby assist in driving to avoid collision.
- At least one of the imaging sections 12101 to 12104 may be an infrared camera that detects infrared rays.
- the microcomputer 12051 can, for example, recognize a pedestrian by determining whether or not there is a pedestrian in imaged images of the imaging sections 12101 to 12104 .
- recognition of a pedestrian is, for example, performed by a procedure of extracting characteristic points in the imaged images of the imaging sections 12101 to 12104 as infrared cameras and a procedure of determining whether or not it is the pedestrian by performing pattern matching processing on a series of characteristic points representing the contour of the object.
- the sound/image output section 12052 controls the display section 12062 so that a square contour line for emphasis is displayed so as to be superimposed on the recognized pedestrian.
- the sound/image output section 12052 may also control the display section 12062 so that an icon or the like representing the pedestrian is displayed at a desired position.
- the technology according to the present disclosure may be applied to the imaging section 12031 and the like out of the components described above. Applying the technology according to the present disclosure to the imaging section 12031 makes it possible to obtain a captured image that is easier to see. This makes it possible to decrease fatigue of a driver. In addition, it is possible to obtain a captured image that is easier to recognize, which makes it possible to improve the accuracy of driving assistance.
- the respective configurations of the solid-state imaging device according to the present embodiment described above e.g., the respective configurations of the solid-state imaging devices 1 to 21 e illustrated in FIG. 1 and FIGS. 6 A, 6 B, 6 C, 6 D, 6 E, 6 F, 6 G, 6 H, 6 I, 6 J, 6 K, 6 L, 6 M, 7 A, 7 B, 7 C, 7 D, 8 A, 8 B, 8 C, 8 D , 8 E, 8 F, 9 A, 9 B, 9 C, 9 D, 10 A, 10 B, 10 C, 10 D, 10 E, 10 F, 11 A, 11 B, 11 C, 11 D, 11 E, 12 A, 12 B, 12 C, 12 D, 13 A, 13 B, 13 C, 13 D, 13 E, 13 F, 14 A, 14 B, 14 C, 14 D, 15 A, 15 B, 15 C, 15 D, 15 E, 15 F, 16 A, 16 B, 16 C, 16 D, 16 E, 16 F, 17 A, 17 B, 17 C, 17
- the configurations of the respective solid-state imaging devices according to the present embodiment described above are only examples of the technology according to the present disclosure.
- a solid-state imaging device may be provided that has various coupling structures that are not included in the embodiment described above.
- a solid-state imaging device including:
- a first substrate including a first semiconductor substrate and a first multi-layered wiring layer stacked on the first semiconductor substrate, the first semiconductor substrate having a pixel unit formed thereon, the pixel unit having pixels arranged thereon;
- a second substrate including a second semiconductor substrate and a second multi-layered wiring layer stacked on the second semiconductor substrate, the second semiconductor substrate having a circuit formed thereon, the circuit having a predetermined function;
- a third substrate including a third semiconductor substrate and a third multi-layered wiring layer stacked on the third semiconductor substrate, the third semiconductor substrate having a circuit formed thereon, the circuit having a predetermined function
- the first substrate, the second substrate, and the third substrate being stacked in this order
- the first substrate and the second substrate being bonded together in a manner that the first multi-layered wiring layer and the second multi-layered wiring layer are opposed to each other,
- a first coupling structure for electrically coupling at least two of the first substrate, the second substrate, or the third substrate to each other including a via
- the via having a structure in which an electrically-conductive material is embedded in one through hole provided to expose a predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer while exposing a portion of a predetermined wiring line in the first multi-layered wiring layer from a back surface side of the first substrate, or one through hole provided to expose a predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer while exposing a portion of the predetermined wiring line in the first multi-layered wiring layer or the second multi-layered wiring layer from the back surface side of the first substrate, or a structure in which a film including an electrically-conductive material is formed on an inner wall of the through hole.
- the solid-state imaging device further including a second coupling structure for electrically coupling the second substrate and the third substrate to each other, in which
- the second coupling structure includes an opening provided by penetrating at least the first substrate from the back surface side of the first substrate to expose a predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer, and an opening provided by penetrating at least the first substrate and the second substrate from the back surface side of the first substrate to expose a predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer.
- the solid-state imaging device in which the predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer that is exposed by the opening and the predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer that is exposed by the opening include pads that function as I/O units.
- a film including an electrically-conductive material is formed on an inner wall of the opening, and
- the predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer that is exposed by the opening and the predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer that is exposed by the opening are electrically coupled to the pads by the electrically-conductive material.
- the solid-state imaging device according to (4), in which the predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer and the predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer are electrically coupled to the same pad by the electrically-conductive material.
- the solid-state imaging device according to (4), in which the predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer and the predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer are electrically coupled to the pads by the electrically-conductive material, the pads being different from each other.
- the solid-state imaging device according to any one of (1) to (6), further including a second coupling structure for electrically coupling the second substrate and the third substrate to each other, in which
- the second substrate and the third substrate are bonded together in a manner that the second semiconductor substrate and the third multi-layered wiring layer are opposed to each other, and
- the second coupling structure includes a via that is provided by penetrating at least the second substrate from a front surface side of the second substrate and electrically couples a predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer and a predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer to each other, or a via that is provided by penetrating at least the third substrate from a back surface side of the third substrate and electrically couples a predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer and a predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer to each other.
- the solid-state imaging device in which the via for the second coupling structure has a structure in which electrically-conductive materials are embedded in a first through hole that exposes the predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer and a second through hole that exposes the predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer and is different from the first through hole, or a structure in which films including electrically-conductive materials are formed on inner walls of the first through hole and the second through hole.
- the solid-state imaging device in which the via for the second coupling structure has a structure in which an electrically-conductive material is embedded in one through hole provided to expose the predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer while exposing a portion of the predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer, or one through hole provided to expose the predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer while exposing a portion of the predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer, or a structure in which a film including an electrically-conductive material is formed on an inner wall of the through hole.
- the solid-state imaging device according to any one of (1) to (9), further including a third coupling structure for electrically coupling the first substrate and the third substrate to each other, in which
- the second substrate and the third substrate are bonded together in a manner that the second semiconductor substrate and the third multi-layered wiring layer are opposed to each other, and
- the third coupling structure includes a via that is provided by penetrating at least the first substrate and the second substrate from a back surface side of the first substrate and electrically couples a predetermined wiring line in the first multi-layered wiring layer and a predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer to each other, or a via that is provided by penetrating at least the third substrate and the second substrate from a back surface side of the third substrate and electrically couples a predetermined wiring line in the first multi-layered wiring layer and a predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer to each other.
- the solid-state imaging device in which the via for the third coupling structure has a structure in which electrically-conductive materials are embedded in a first through hole that exposes the predetermined wiring line in the first multi-layered wiring layer and a second through hole that exposes the predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer and is different from the first through hole, or a structure in which films including electrically-conductive materials are formed on inner walls of the first through hole and the second through hole.
- the solid-state imaging device in which the via for the third coupling structure has a structure in which an electrically-conductive material is embedded in one through hole provided to expose the predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer while exposing a portion of the predetermined wiring line in the first multi-layered wiring layer, or one through hole provided to expose the predetermined wiring line in the first multi-layered wiring layer while exposing a portion of the predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer, or a structure in which a film including an electrically-conductive material is formed on an inner wall of the through hole.
- the solid-state imaging device in which the via for the third coupling structure is also electrically coupled to a predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer.
- the solid-state imaging device according to any one of (1) to (13), further including a second coupling structure for electrically coupling the second substrate and the third substrate to each other, in which
- the second coupling structure exists on bonding surfaces of the second substrate and the third substrate, and includes an electrode junction structure in which electrodes formed on the respective bonding surfaces are joined to each other in direct contact with each other.
- the solid-state imaging device according to any one of (1) to (14), in which the second substrate and the third substrate include at least one of a logic circuit or a memory circuit, the logic circuit executing various kinds of signal processing related to an operation of the solid-state imaging device, the memory circuit temporarily holding a pixel signal acquired by each of the pixels of the first substrate.
- An electronic apparatus including
- the solid-state imaging device including
- a first substrate including a first semiconductor substrate and a first multi-layered wiring layer stacked on the first semiconductor substrate, the first semiconductor substrate having a pixel unit formed thereon, the pixel unit having pixels arranged thereon,
- a second substrate including a second semiconductor substrate and a second multi-layered wiring layer stacked on the second semiconductor substrate, the second semiconductor substrate having a circuit formed thereon, the circuit having a predetermined function, and
- a third substrate including a third semiconductor substrate and a third multi-layered wiring layer stacked on the third semiconductor substrate, the third semiconductor substrate having a circuit formed thereon, the circuit having a predetermined function
- the first substrate, the second substrate, and the third substrate being stacked in this order
- the first substrate and the second substrate being bonded together in a manner that the first multi-layered wiring layer and the second multi-layered wiring layer are opposed to each other,
- a first coupling structure for electrically coupling at least two of the first substrate, the second substrate, or the third substrate to each other including a via
- the via having a structure in which an electrically-conductive material is embedded in one through hole provided to expose a predetermined wiring line in the second multi-layered wiring layer while exposing a portion of a predetermined wiring line in the first multi-layered wiring layer from a back surface side of the first substrate, or one through hole provided to expose a predetermined wiring line in the third multi-layered wiring layer while exposing a portion of the predetermined wiring line in the first multi-layered wiring layer or the second multi-layered wiring layer from the back surface side of the first substrate, or a structure in which a film including an electrically-conductive material is formed on an inner wall of the through hole.
Abstract
Description
- PTL 1: Japanese Unexamined Patent Application Publication No. 2014-99582
- 1, 1 a to 1 c, 2 a to 2 m, 3 a to 3 d, 4 a to 4 f, 5 a to 5 d, 6 a to 6 f, 7 a to 7 e, 8 a to 8 d, 9 a to 9 f, 10 a to 10 d, 11 a to 11 f, 12 a to 12 f, 13 a to 13 e, 14 a to 14 j, 15 a to 15 e, 16 a to 16 f, 17 a to 17 f, 18 a to 18 e, 19 a to 19 j, 20 a to 20 e, 21 a to 21 e solid-state imaging device
- 101, 121, 131 semiconductor substrate
- 103, 109, 123, 129, 133 insulating film
- 105, 125, 135 multi-layered wiring layer
- 110A first substrate
- 110B second substrate
- 110C third substrate
- 111 CF layer
- 113 ML array
- 151 pad
- 153, 153 a, 153 b, 153 c pad opening
- 155, 155 a, 155 b, 155 c lead line opening
- 157, 157 a, 157 b TSV
- 159 electrode junction structure
- 501 electrically-conductive material film
- 503 resin film
- 901 smartphone (electronic apparatus)
- 911 digital camera (electronic apparatus)
Claims (15)
Applications Claiming Priority (7)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
JP2017-074804 | 2017-04-04 | ||
JPJP2017-074804 | 2017-04-04 | ||
JP2017074804 | 2017-04-04 | ||
JP2017-130386 | 2017-07-03 | ||
JP2017130386 | 2017-07-03 | ||
JPJP2017-130386 | 2017-07-03 | ||
PCT/JP2018/011566 WO2018186193A1 (en) | 2017-04-04 | 2018-03-23 | Solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus |
Publications (2)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20200243591A1 US20200243591A1 (en) | 2020-07-30 |
US11594567B2 true US11594567B2 (en) | 2023-02-28 |
Family
ID=63712836
Family Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US16/495,310 Active 2038-10-23 US11594567B2 (en) | 2017-04-04 | 2018-03-23 | Solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus |
Country Status (2)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (1) | US11594567B2 (en) |
WO (1) | WO2018186193A1 (en) |
Families Citing this family (4)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
WO2018186198A1 (en) * | 2017-04-04 | 2018-10-11 | ソニーセミコンダクタソリューションズ株式会社 | Solid state imaging device and electronic apparatus |
WO2018186027A1 (en) * | 2017-04-04 | 2018-10-11 | ソニーセミコンダクタソリューションズ株式会社 | Semiconductor device, method for manufacturing semiconductor device, and electronic instrument |
CN109817659B (en) * | 2019-02-15 | 2021-08-06 | 京东方科技集团股份有限公司 | Display substrate, manufacturing method thereof and display device |
US11043469B1 (en) * | 2020-02-19 | 2021-06-22 | Nanya Technology Corporation | Method of forming three dimensional semiconductor structure |
Citations (6)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20120086094A1 (en) * | 2010-10-12 | 2012-04-12 | Sony Corporation | Solid-state imaging device, manufacturing method of solid-state imaging device, and electronic equipment |
US20130020468A1 (en) * | 2011-07-19 | 2013-01-24 | Sony Corporation | Solid-state imaging device, manufacturing method of solid-state imaging device, manufacturing method of semiconductor device, semiconductor device, and electronic device |
WO2014061240A1 (en) | 2012-10-18 | 2014-04-24 | Sony Corporation | Semiconductor device, solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus |
WO2015093017A1 (en) | 2013-12-19 | 2015-06-25 | Sony Corporation | Semiconductor device, method of manufacturing semiconductor device, and electronic apparatus |
WO2016143288A1 (en) | 2015-03-12 | 2016-09-15 | Sony Corporation | Imaging device, manufacturing method, and electronic device |
TW201633524A (en) | 2015-03-12 | 2016-09-16 | 新力股份有限公司 | Imaging device, manufacturing method, and electronic device |
-
2018
- 2018-03-23 US US16/495,310 patent/US11594567B2/en active Active
- 2018-03-23 WO PCT/JP2018/011566 patent/WO2018186193A1/en active Application Filing
Patent Citations (22)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20120086094A1 (en) * | 2010-10-12 | 2012-04-12 | Sony Corporation | Solid-state imaging device, manufacturing method of solid-state imaging device, and electronic equipment |
US20130020468A1 (en) * | 2011-07-19 | 2013-01-24 | Sony Corporation | Solid-state imaging device, manufacturing method of solid-state imaging device, manufacturing method of semiconductor device, semiconductor device, and electronic device |
EP2909862A1 (en) | 2012-10-18 | 2015-08-26 | Sony Corporation | Semiconductor device, solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus |
WO2014061240A1 (en) | 2012-10-18 | 2014-04-24 | Sony Corporation | Semiconductor device, solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus |
JP2014099582A (en) | 2012-10-18 | 2014-05-29 | Sony Corp | Solid-state imaging device |
KR20150066527A (en) | 2012-10-18 | 2015-06-16 | 소니 주식회사 | Semiconductor device, solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus |
CN104718622A (en) | 2012-10-18 | 2015-06-17 | 索尼公司 | Semiconductor device, solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus |
TW201417255A (en) | 2012-10-18 | 2014-05-01 | Sony Corp | Semiconductor device, solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus |
US20150270307A1 (en) * | 2012-10-18 | 2015-09-24 | Sony Corporation | Semiconductor device, solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus |
WO2015093017A1 (en) | 2013-12-19 | 2015-06-25 | Sony Corporation | Semiconductor device, method of manufacturing semiconductor device, and electronic apparatus |
JP2015135938A (en) | 2013-12-19 | 2015-07-27 | ソニー株式会社 | Semiconductor device, method of manufacturing semiconductor device, and electronic apparatus |
TW201526219A (en) | 2013-12-19 | 2015-07-01 | Sony Corp | Semiconductor device, method of manufacturing semiconductor device, and electronic apparatus |
CN105593995A (en) | 2013-12-19 | 2016-05-18 | 索尼公司 | Semiconductor device, method of manufacturing semiconductor device, and electronic apparatus |
KR20160100904A (en) | 2013-12-19 | 2016-08-24 | 소니 주식회사 | Semiconductor device, method of manufacturing semiconductor device, and electronic apparatus |
US20160284753A1 (en) * | 2013-12-19 | 2016-09-29 | Sony Corporation | Semiconductor device, method of manufacturing semiconductor device, and electronic apparatus |
EP3084831A1 (en) | 2013-12-19 | 2016-10-26 | Sony Corporation | Semiconductor device, method of manufacturing semiconductor device, and electronic apparatus |
WO2016143288A1 (en) | 2015-03-12 | 2016-09-15 | Sony Corporation | Imaging device, manufacturing method, and electronic device |
TW201633524A (en) | 2015-03-12 | 2016-09-16 | 新力股份有限公司 | Imaging device, manufacturing method, and electronic device |
JP2016171297A (en) | 2015-03-12 | 2016-09-23 | ソニー株式会社 | Solid-state imaging device, manufacturing method, and electronic device |
CN107278328A (en) | 2015-03-12 | 2017-10-20 | 索尼公司 | Camera device, its manufacture method and electronic equipment |
KR20170124538A (en) | 2015-03-12 | 2017-11-10 | 소니 주식회사 | Solid-state imaging device, manufacturing method, and electronic device |
EP3268990A1 (en) | 2015-03-12 | 2018-01-17 | Sony Corporation | Imaging device, manufacturing method, and electronic device |
Non-Patent Citations (1)
Title |
---|
International Search Report and Written Opinion of PCT Application No. PCT/JP2018/011566, dated Jun. 5, 2018, 10 pages of ISRWO. |
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
WO2018186193A1 (en) | 2018-10-11 |
US20200243591A1 (en) | 2020-07-30 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US11955500B2 (en) | Solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus | |
US20230020137A1 (en) | Solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus | |
US20230154964A1 (en) | Imaging element | |
US11948961B2 (en) | Solid-state imaging device and electronic device including coupling structures for electrically interconnecting stacked semiconductor substrates | |
US20210366973A1 (en) | Solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus | |
US20210391372A1 (en) | Solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus | |
CN110914993B (en) | Solid-state image pickup device | |
US11804507B2 (en) | Solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus | |
US11127773B2 (en) | Semiconductor device, method of manufacturing semiconductor device, and electronic apparatus | |
US20220359603A1 (en) | Solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus | |
US11594567B2 (en) | Solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus | |
US20220085110A1 (en) | Solid-state imaging element, electronic device, and manufacturing method of solid-state imaging element | |
US20240088191A1 (en) | Photoelectric conversion device and electronic apparatus | |
CN110494981B (en) | Solid-state imaging device and electronic apparatus | |
US20240055460A1 (en) | Solid-state imaging device | |
US20210249458A1 (en) | Imaging device |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: SONY SEMICONDUCTOR SOLUTIONS CORPORATION, JAPAN Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:IIJIMA, TADASHI;KAMESHIMA, TAKATOSHI;MITSUHASHI, IKUE;AND OTHERS;SIGNING DATES FROM 20190827 TO 20190906;REEL/FRAME:050422/0973 |
|
FEPP | Fee payment procedure |
Free format text: ENTITY STATUS SET TO UNDISCOUNTED (ORIGINAL EVENT CODE: BIG.); ENTITY STATUS OF PATENT OWNER: LARGE ENTITY |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: DOCKETED NEW CASE - READY FOR EXAMINATION |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: NON FINAL ACTION MAILED |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: RESPONSE TO NON-FINAL OFFICE ACTION ENTERED AND FORWARDED TO EXAMINER |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: FINAL REJECTION COUNTED, NOT YET MAILED |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: FINAL REJECTION MAILED |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: RESPONSE AFTER FINAL ACTION FORWARDED TO EXAMINER |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: ADVISORY ACTION MAILED |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: DOCKETED NEW CASE - READY FOR EXAMINATION |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: NON FINAL ACTION MAILED |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: RESPONSE TO NON-FINAL OFFICE ACTION ENTERED AND FORWARDED TO EXAMINER |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: NOTICE OF ALLOWANCE MAILED -- APPLICATION RECEIVED IN OFFICE OF PUBLICATIONS |
|
STCF | Information on status: patent grant |
Free format text: PATENTED CASE |